blob: cc4ecad90a6dd023b3ffa8c2f135bc8536dd50cb [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau442e8342010-11-11 23:29:35 +01007 2010/11/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100438 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - nbproc
440 - pidfile
441 - uid
442 - ulimit-n
443 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200444 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200445 - node
446 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100447 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 * Performance tuning
450 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100451 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - noepoll
453 - nokqueue
454 - nopoll
455 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100456 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200457 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200458 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200459 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100460 - tune.maxaccept
461 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200462 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100463 - tune.rcvbuf.client
464 - tune.rcvbuf.server
465 - tune.sndbuf.client
466 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100467
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 * Debugging
469 - debug
470 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200471
472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004733.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474------------------------------------
475
476chroot <jail dir>
477 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
478 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
479 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
480 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
481 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
482 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100483
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484daemon
485 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
486 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
487 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
488
489gid <number>
490 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
491 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
492 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
493 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100494
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200495group <group name>
496 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
497 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200499log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
501 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100502 configured with "log global".
503
504 <address> can be one of:
505
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100506 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100507 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
508 port).
509
510 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
511 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
512 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
513 writeable).
514
515 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516
517 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
518 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
519 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
520
521 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200522 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
523 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
524 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
525 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
526 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
527 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200528
529 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
530
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100531log-send-hostname [<string>]
532 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
533 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
534 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
535 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
536 the logs.
537
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000538log-tag <string>
539 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
540 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
541 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
542 running on the same host.
543
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544nbproc <number>
545 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
546 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
547 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
548 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
549 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
550
551pidfile <pidfile>
552 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
553 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
554 starting the process. See also "daemon".
555
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200556stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200557 [level <level>]
558
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200559 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
560 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100561 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200562 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
563
564 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
565 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
566 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
567 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
568 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
569
570 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
571 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
572 counters).
573
574 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
575 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100576
577 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
578 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
579 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
580 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
581 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
582 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
583 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584
585stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
586 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
587 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100588 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200589
590stats maxconn <connections>
591 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
592 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
593
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594uid <number>
595 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
596 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
597 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
598 one. See also "gid" and "user".
599
600ulimit-n <number>
601 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
602 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
603 option.
604
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100605unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
606 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
607
608 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
609 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
610 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
611 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
612 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
613 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
614 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
615 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
616 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
617 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
618
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200619user <user name>
620 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
621 See also "uid" and "group".
622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200623node <name>
624 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
625
626 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
627 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
628 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
629 traffic.
630
631description <text>
632 Add a text that describes the instance.
633
634 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
635 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
636 "<" and ">" characters.
637
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006393.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200640-----------------------
641
642maxconn <number>
643 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
644 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
645 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
646 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
647
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100648maxpipes <number>
649 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
650 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
651 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
652 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
653 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
654 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
655
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656noepoll
657 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
658 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
659 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
660
661nokqueue
662 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
663 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
664 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
665
666nopoll
667 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
668 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100669 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
671 "nokqueue".
672
673nosepoll
674 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
675 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
676 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
677
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100678nosplice
679 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
680 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
681 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100682 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100683 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
684 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
685 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
686 "option splice-response".
687
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200688spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
689 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
690 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
691 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
692 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
693 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
694
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200695tune.bufsize <number>
696 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
697 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
698 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
699 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
700 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
701 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
702 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
703 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
704
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200705tune.chksize <number>
706 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
707 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
708 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
709 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
710 checks whenever possible.
711
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100712tune.maxaccept <number>
713 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
714 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
715 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100716 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100717 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
718 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100719 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100720 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
721
722tune.maxpollevents <number>
723 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
724 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
725 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
726 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
727 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
728
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200729tune.maxrewrite <number>
730 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
731 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
732 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
733 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
734 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
735 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
736 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
737 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
738 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
739 bufsize.
740
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100741tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
742tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
743 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
744 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
745 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
746 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
747 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
748 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
749 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
750
751tune.sndbuf.client <number>
752tune.sndbuf.server <number>
753 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
754 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
755 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
756 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
757 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
758 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
759 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
760 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
761 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
762 notifying haproxy again.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007653.3. Debugging
766--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200767
768debug
769 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
770 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
771 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
772 system startup.
773
774quiet
775 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
776 line argument "-q".
777
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007793.4. Userlists
780--------------
781It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
782http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
783it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
784
785userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100786 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100787 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
788
789group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100790 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100791 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
792 proceeded by "users" keyword.
793
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100794user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
795 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100796 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
797 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100798 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
799 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100800 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
801 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
802
803
804 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100805 userlist L1
806 group G1 users tiger,scott
807 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100808
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100809 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
810 user scott insecure-password elgato
811 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100812
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100813 userlist L2
814 group G1
815 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100816
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100817 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
818 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
819 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100820
821 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200823
8243.5. Peers
825--------------
826It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
827haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
828pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
829identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
830or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
831Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
832known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
833the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
834process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
835during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
836tables.
837
838peers <peersect>
839 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
840 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
841
842peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
843 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
844 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
845 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
846 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
847 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
848 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
849
850 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
851 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
852
853 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
854 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
855 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
856 across all peers.
857
858Example:
859 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100860 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
861 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
862 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200863
864 backend mybackend
865 mode tcp
866 balance roundrobin
867 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
868 stick on src
869
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100870 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
871 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200872
873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008744. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200875----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100876
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
878 - defaults <name>
879 - frontend <name>
880 - backend <name>
881 - listen <name>
882
883A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
884its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
885section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100886section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200887
888A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
889connections.
890
891A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
892to forward incoming connections.
893
894A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
895parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100897All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
898'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
899case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
900
901Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
902logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
903proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
904However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
905name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
906
907Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
908and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100909bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100910protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
911modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
912arbitrary criteria.
913
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009154.1. Proxy keywords matrix
916--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200918The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
919limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
920they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
921limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100922marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200923option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200924and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
925with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
926specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100927
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200928
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100929 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
930------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
931acl - X X X
932appsession - - X X
933backlog X X X -
934balance X - X X
935bind - X X -
936bind-process X X X X
937block - X X X
938capture cookie - X X -
939capture request header - X X -
940capture response header - X X -
941clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
942contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
943cookie X - X X
944default-server X - X X
945default_backend X X X -
946description - X X X
947disabled X X X X
948dispatch - - X X
949enabled X X X X
950errorfile X X X X
951errorloc X X X X
952errorloc302 X X X X
953-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
954errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200955force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100956fullconn X - X X
957grace X X X X
958hash-type X - X X
959http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100960http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200961http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100962http-request - X X X
963id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200964ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100965log X X X X
966maxconn X X X -
967mode X X X X
968monitor fail - X X -
969monitor-net X X X -
970monitor-uri X X X -
971option abortonclose (*) X - X X
972option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
973option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
974option allbackups (*) X - X X
975option checkcache (*) X - X X
976option clitcpka (*) X X X -
977option contstats (*) X X X -
978option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
979option dontlognull (*) X X X -
980option forceclose (*) X X X X
981-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
982option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200983option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100984option http-server-close (*) X X X X
985option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
986option httpchk X - X X
987option httpclose (*) X X X X
988option httplog X X X X
989option http_proxy (*) X X X X
990option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200991option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100992option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
993option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
994option logasap (*) X X X -
995option mysql-check X - X X
996option nolinger (*) X X X X
997option originalto X X X X
998option persist (*) X - X X
999option redispatch (*) X - X X
1000option smtpchk X - X X
1001option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1002option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1003option splice-request (*) X X X X
1004option splice-response (*) X X X X
1005option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1006option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1007-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1008option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1009option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1010option tcpka X X X X
1011option tcplog X X X X
1012option transparent (*) X - X X
1013persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1014rate-limit sessions X X X -
1015redirect - X X X
1016redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1017redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1018reqadd - X X X
1019reqallow - X X X
1020reqdel - X X X
1021reqdeny - X X X
1022reqiallow - X X X
1023reqidel - X X X
1024reqideny - X X X
1025reqipass - X X X
1026reqirep - X X X
1027reqisetbe - X X X
1028reqitarpit - X X X
1029reqpass - X X X
1030reqrep - X X X
1031-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1032reqsetbe - X X X
1033reqtarpit - X X X
1034retries X - X X
1035rspadd - X X X
1036rspdel - X X X
1037rspdeny - X X X
1038rspidel - X X X
1039rspideny - X X X
1040rspirep - X X X
1041rsprep - X X X
1042server - - X X
1043source X - X X
1044srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001045stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001046stats auth X - X X
1047stats enable X - X X
1048stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001049stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001050stats realm X - X X
1051stats refresh X - X X
1052stats scope X - X X
1053stats show-desc X - X X
1054stats show-legends X - X X
1055stats show-node X - X X
1056stats uri X - X X
1057-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1058stick match - - X X
1059stick on - - X X
1060stick store-request - - X X
1061stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001062tcp-request connection - X X -
1063tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001064tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001065tcp-response content - - X X
1066tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001067timeout check X - X X
1068timeout client X X X -
1069timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1070timeout connect X - X X
1071timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1072timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1073timeout http-request X X X X
1074timeout queue X - X X
1075timeout server X - X X
1076timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1077timeout tarpit X X X X
1078transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1079use_backend - X X -
1080------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1081 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010844.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1085---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001086
1087This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1088
1089
1090acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1091 Declare or complete an access list.
1092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1093 no | yes | yes | yes
1094 Example:
1095 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1096 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1097 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001099 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001100
1101
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001102appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1103 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001104 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1106 no | no | yes | yes
1107 Arguments :
1108 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1109 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1110
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001111 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001112 checked in each cookie value.
1113
1114 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1115 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1116 milliseconds.
1117
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001118 request-learn
1119 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1120 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1121 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1122 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1123 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1124 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1125
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001126 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1127 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1128 data following this prefix.
1129
1130 Example :
1131 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1132
1133 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1134 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1135
1136 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1137 2 modes are currently supported :
1138 - path-parameters :
1139 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1140 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1141 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1142 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1143 - query-string :
1144 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1145 query string.
1146
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001147 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1148 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1149 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1150 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001151 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1152 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1153 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001154 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1155 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1156
1157 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1158
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001159 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1160 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1161 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1162
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001163 Example :
1164 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1165
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001166 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1167 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001168
1169
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001170backlog <conns>
1171 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1173 yes | yes | yes | no
1174 Arguments :
1175 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1176 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1177 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1178
1179 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1180 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1181 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1182 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1183 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1184 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1185 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1186 backlog parameter.
1187
1188 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1189 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1190 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1191
1192 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1193
1194
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001195balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001196balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001197 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1199 yes | no | yes | yes
1200 Arguments :
1201 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1202 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1203 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1204 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1205
1206 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1207 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1208 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1209 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001210 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1211 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1212 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1213 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1214 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1215 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1216 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1217 it, so that you don't worry.
1218
1219 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1220 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1221 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1222 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1223 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1224 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1225 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1226 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001227
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001228 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1229 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1230 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1231 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1232 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1233 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1234 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1235 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001237 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1238 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1239 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1240 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1241 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1242 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1243 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1244 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001245 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001246 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001247 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1248 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1249 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001250
1251 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1252 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1253 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1254 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1255 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1256 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1257 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001258 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1259 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1260 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001261
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001262 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1263 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1264 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1265 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1266 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1267 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1268 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1269 URIs start with a leading "/".
1270
1271 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1272 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1273 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1274 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001277 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1278
1279 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1280 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1281 when the question mark indicating a query string ('?') is not
1282 present in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1283 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1284 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1285 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1286 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1287 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1288 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1289 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1290 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1291 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1292 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1293 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1294 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1295 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1296 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1297 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1298 be randomly balanced if at all.
1299
1300 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1301 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1302 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1303 server will receive the request.
1304
1305 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1306 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1307 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1308 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1309 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001310 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1311 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1312 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001313
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001314 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1315 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1316 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001317 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001318 algorithm is applied instead.
1319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001320 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001321 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1322 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1323 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1324
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001325 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1326 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1327 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1328
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001329 rdp-cookie
1330 rdp-cookie(name)
1331 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1332 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1333 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1334 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1335 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1336 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001337 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001338 used instead.
1339
1340 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1341 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1342 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1343 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1344
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001345 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1346 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1347 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1348
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001349 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001350 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1351 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001352
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001353 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001354 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001355
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001356 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1357 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1358 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001359
1360 Examples :
1361 balance roundrobin
1362 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001363 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001364 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1365 balance hdr(host)
1366 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001367
1368 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1369 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001371 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001372 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1373 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1374 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1375 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1376
1377 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1378 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1379 defaults to 16 kB.
1380
1381 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1382 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1383
1384 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1385 Round Robin.
1386
1387 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1388 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1389 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1390 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1391
1392 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1393
1394 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001395 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001396 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1397 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1398 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001399
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001400 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1401 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001402
1403
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001404bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1405bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1406bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1407bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1408bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1409bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1410bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001411bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001412bind /<path> [, ...]
1413bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1414bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1415bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001416 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1418 no | yes | yes | no
1419 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001420 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1421 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1422 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1423 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
1424 special address "0.0.0.0".
1425
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001426 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1427 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001428 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1429 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1430 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001431 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1432 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1433 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1434 the range.
1435
1436 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1437 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1438 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1439 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1440 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1441 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1442 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1443 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1444 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001445
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001446 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1447 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1448 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1449 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1450 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1451 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1452 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1453 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1454
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001455 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1456 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1457 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1458 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1459 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1460 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1461 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1462 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001463 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1464 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001465
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001466 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1467 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1468 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1469 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1470 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1471 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001472 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1473 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1474 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1475 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1476 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1477 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1478 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1479 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001480
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001481 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1482 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1483 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1484 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001485
1486 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1487
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001488 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1489 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1490 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1491 simply ignore this.
1492
1493 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1494 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1495 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1496 simply ignore this.
1497
1498 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1499 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1500 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1501 this.
1502
1503 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1504 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1505 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1506 this.
1507
1508 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1509 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1510 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1511 this.
1512
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001513 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1514 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1515 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001516 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001517 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1518 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1519 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1520 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001521 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1522 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001523
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001524 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001525 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1526 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1527 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1528 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1529 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1530 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1531 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1532 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1533 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1534 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1535 with front firewalls which would see an established
1536 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1537
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001538 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1539 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1540 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1541 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1542 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1543 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1544 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1545 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1546 This keyword combined with support from external components
1547 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1548 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1549 not even always usable.
1550
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001551 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1552 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1553 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1554 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1555 in a frontend.
1556
1557 Example :
1558 listen http_proxy
1559 bind :80,:443
1560 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001561 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001562
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001563 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001564 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001565
1566
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001567bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1568 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1570 yes | yes | yes | yes
1571 Arguments :
1572 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1573 may be used to override a default value.
1574
1575 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1576 option may be combined with other numbers.
1577
1578 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1579 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1580 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1581 missing from all processes.
1582
1583 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1584 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1585 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1586 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1587
1588 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1589 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1590 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1591 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1592 and 'even' instances.
1593
1594 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1595 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1596 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1597 32.
1598
1599 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1600 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1601
1602 Example :
1603 listen app_ip1
1604 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001605 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001606
1607 listen app_ip2
1608 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001609 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001610
1611 listen management
1612 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001613 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001614
1615 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1616
1617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618block { if | unless } <condition>
1619 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1621 no | yes | yes | yes
1622
1623 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1624 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001625 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001626 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1627 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1628 "block" statements per instance.
1629
1630 Example:
1631 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1632 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1633 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1634 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001636 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001637
1638
1639capture cookie <name> len <length>
1640 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1642 no | yes | yes | no
1643 Arguments :
1644 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1645 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1646 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1647 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1648 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1649
1650 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1651 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1652 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1653 right if it exceeds <length>.
1654
1655 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1656 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1657 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1658 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1659
1660 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1661 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1662 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1663
1664 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1665 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1666 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1667 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001668 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001669 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1670
1671 Example:
1672 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1673
1674 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001675 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001676
1677
1678capture request header <name> len <length>
1679 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1681 no | yes | yes | no
1682 Arguments :
1683 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001684 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001685 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1686 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1687 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1688
1689 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1690 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1691 it exceeds <length>.
1692
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001693 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001694 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1695 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001696 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1697 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1698 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1699 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001700 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001701 environments to find where the request came from.
1702
1703 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1704 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1705 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1706 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001707
1708 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1709 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1710 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1711 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1712
1713 Example:
1714 capture request header Host len 15
1715 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1716 capture request header Referrer len 15
1717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001718 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719 about logging.
1720
1721
1722capture response header <name> len <length>
1723 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1725 no | yes | yes | no
1726 Arguments :
1727 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001728 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001729 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1730 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1731 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1732
1733 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1734 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1735 it exceeds <length>.
1736
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001737 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001738 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1739 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1740 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001741 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1742 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1743 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1744 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001745
1746 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1747 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1748 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1749 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1750
1751 Example:
1752 capture response header Content-length len 9
1753 capture response header Location len 15
1754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001755 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001756 about logging.
1757
1758
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001759clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001760 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1762 yes | yes | yes | no
1763 Arguments :
1764 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1765 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1766 as explained at the top of this document.
1767
1768 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1769 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1770 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1771 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1772 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1773 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1774 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1775 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001776 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001777 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1778 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1779
1780 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1781 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1782 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1783 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1784 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1785 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1786
1787 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1788 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1789
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001790 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1791 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001792
1793
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001794contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1797 yes | no | yes | yes
1798 Arguments :
1799 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1800 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1801 as explained at the top of this document.
1802
1803 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001804 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001805 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1807 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1808 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1809 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1810
1811 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1812 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1813 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1814 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1815 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1816 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1817
1818 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1819 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1820 instead.
1821
1822 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1823 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1824
1825
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001826cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001827 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001828 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001829 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1831 yes | no | yes | yes
1832 Arguments :
1833 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1834 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1835 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1836 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1837 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1838 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1839 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1840 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1841 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1842
1843 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1844 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1845 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1846 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1847 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1848 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1849 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1850 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1851 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1852 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1853 "insert" and "prefix".
1854
1855 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001856 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001857
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001858 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001859 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1860 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1861 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1862 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1863 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1864 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1865 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1866 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1867 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1868 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869
1870 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1871 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1872 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1873 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1874 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1875 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1876 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1877 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1878 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1879 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1880 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1881
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001882 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1883 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1884 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001885 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1886 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1887 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1888 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889
1890 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1891 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1892 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1893 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1894 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1895 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1896 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1897 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1898 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1899
1900 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1901 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1902 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1903 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1904 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1905 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1906 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1907 persistence cookie in the cache.
1908 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1909
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001910 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1911 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1912 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1913 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1914 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1915 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1916 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1917 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1918 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1919 they logout.
1920
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001921 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001922 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001923 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1924 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1925 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1926 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1927 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1928 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001929
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001930 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1931 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1932 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1933 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1934 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1935 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1936 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1937 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1938 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1939 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1940 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1941 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1942 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1943 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1944 the site.
1945
1946 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1947 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1948 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1949 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1950 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1951 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1952 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1953 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1954 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1955 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1956 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1957 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1958 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1959 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1960 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1961 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1962
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001963 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1964 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1965 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1966 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001967
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001968 Examples :
1969 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1970 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1971 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001972 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001973
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001974 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001975 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001976
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001977
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001978default-server [param*]
1979 Change default options for a server in a backend
1980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1981 yes | no | yes | yes
1982 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001983 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1984 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1985 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1986 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001987
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001988 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001989 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1990
1991 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001993
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001994default_backend <backend>
1995 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1997 yes | yes | yes | no
1998 Arguments :
1999 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2000
2001 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2002 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2003 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2004 will catch all undetermined requests.
2005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002006 Example :
2007
2008 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2009 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2010 default_backend dynamic
2011
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002012 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2013
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002014
2015disabled
2016 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2018 yes | yes | yes | yes
2019 Arguments : none
2020
2021 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2022 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2023 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2024 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2025 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2026 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2027 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2028
2029 See also : "enabled"
2030
2031
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002032dispatch <address>:<port>
2033 Set a default server address
2034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2035 no | no | yes | yes
2036 Arguments : none
2037
2038 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2039 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2040 during start-up.
2041
2042 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2043 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2044 possible with normal servers.
2045
2046 The "disabled" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
2047 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2048 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2049 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2050 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2051
2052 See also : "server"
2053
2054
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002055enabled
2056 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2058 yes | yes | yes | yes
2059 Arguments : none
2060
2061 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2062 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2063
2064 See also : "disabled"
2065
2066
2067errorfile <code> <file>
2068 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2070 yes | yes | yes | yes
2071 Arguments :
2072 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2073 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2074
2075 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002076 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002077 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002078 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2079 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002080
2081 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2082 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2083 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2084
2085 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2086 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2087 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2088 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2089
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002090 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2091 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2092 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2093 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2094 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2095 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2096
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2098 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2099 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002100 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002101 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2102
2103 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2104
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002105 Example :
2106 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2107 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2108 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2109
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002110
2111errorloc <code> <url>
2112errorloc302 <code> <url>
2113 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2115 yes | yes | yes | yes
2116 Arguments :
2117 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2118 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2119
2120 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2121 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2122 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2123 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2124 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2125
2126 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2127 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2128 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2129
2130 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2131 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2132 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2133 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2134 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2135 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2136 request.
2137
2138 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2139
2140
2141errorloc303 <code> <url>
2142 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2144 yes | yes | yes | yes
2145 Arguments :
2146 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2147 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2148
2149 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2150 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2151 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2152 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2153 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2154
2155 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2156 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2157 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2158
2159 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2160 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2161 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2162 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002163 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002164
2165 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2166
2167
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002168force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2169 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2170 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2171 no | yes | yes | yes
2172
2173 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2174 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2175 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2176 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2177 marked down for maintenance operations.
2178
2179 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2180 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2181 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2182 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2183 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2184 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2185 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2186 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2187 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2188
2189 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2190 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2191 is used.
2192
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002193 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002194 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002195
2196
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002197fullconn <conns>
2198 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2200 yes | no | yes | yes
2201 Arguments :
2202 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2203 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2204
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002205 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002206 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002207 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002208 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2209 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2210 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2211 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2212 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002213 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002214
2215 Example :
2216 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2217 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2218 # connections.
2219 backend dynamic
2220 fullconn 10000
2221 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2222 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2223
2224 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2225
2226
2227grace <time>
2228 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002230 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002231 Arguments :
2232 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2233 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2234 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2235
2236 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2237 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002238 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002239 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2240
2241 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2242 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2243 simplify it.
2244
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002246hash-type <method>
2247 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2249 yes | no | yes | yes
2250 Arguments :
2251 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2252 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2253 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2254 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2255 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2256 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2257 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2258 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2259 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2260
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002261 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2262 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2263 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2264 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2265 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2266 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2267 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2268 this value.
2269
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002270 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2271 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2272 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2273 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2274 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2275 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2276 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2277 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2278 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2279 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2280 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2281 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2282 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2283
2284 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2285
2286 See also : "balance", "server"
2287
2288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002289http-check disable-on-404
2290 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002292 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002293 Arguments : none
2294
2295 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2296 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2297 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2298 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2299 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2300 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2301 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2302 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002303 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2304 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2305 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2306
2307 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2308
2309
2310http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2311 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2313 no | no | yes | yes
2314 Arguments :
2315 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2316 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2317 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2318 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2319 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2320 details on the supported keywords.
2321
2322 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2323 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2324 with the usual backslash ('\').
2325
2326 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2327 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2328 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2329 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2330 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2331
2332 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2333 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2334 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2335 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2336 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2337
2338 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2339 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2340 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2341 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2342 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2343 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2344
2345 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2346 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2347 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2348 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2349 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2350 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2351 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2352 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2353 trace).
2354
2355 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2356 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2357 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2358 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2359 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2360 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2361 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2362 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2363
2364 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2365 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2366 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2367 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2368 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2369 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2370 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2371 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2372
2373 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2374 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2375
2376 Examples :
2377 # only accept status 200 as valid
2378 http-request expect status 200
2379
2380 # consider SQL errors as errors
2381 http-request expect ! string SQL\ Error
2382
2383 # consider status 5xx only as errors
2384 http-request expect ! rstatus ^5
2385
2386 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
2387 http-request expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002388
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002389 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002390
2391
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002392http-check send-state
2393 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2395 yes | no | yes | yes
2396 Arguments : none
2397
2398 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2399 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2400 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2401 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2402 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2403
2404 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2405 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2406 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2407 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2408 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2409 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2410 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2411 checked in multiple backends.
2412
2413 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2414 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2415
2416 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2417 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2418 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2419 one fails.
2420
2421 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2422 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2423 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2424
2425 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2426 server's queue.
2427
2428 Example of a header received by the application server :
2429 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2430 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2431
2432 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2433
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002434http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002435 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002436 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2437
2438 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2439 no | yes | yes | yes
2440
2441 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2442 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2443 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002444 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2445 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002446 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2447
2448 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2449 instance.
2450
2451 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002452 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2453 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2454 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002455
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002456 http-request allow if nagios
2457 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2458 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2459 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002460
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002461 Example:
2462 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002463
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002464 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002465
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002466 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2467 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002468
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002469id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002470 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2472 no | yes | yes | yes
2473 Arguments : none
2474
2475 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2476 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2477 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002478
2479
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002480ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2481 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2483 no | yes | yes | yes
2484
2485 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2486 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2487 and running).
2488
2489 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2490 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2491 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2492 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2493 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2494
2495 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2496 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2497
2498 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2499 "unless" condition is met.
2500
2501 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2502
2503
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002504log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002505log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002506 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2508 yes | yes | yes | yes
2509 Arguments :
2510 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2511 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2512 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2513 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2514 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2515 parameter.
2516
2517 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2518 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2519
2520 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2521 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2522 standard syslog port).
2523
2524 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2525 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2526 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2527 appropriately writeable).
2528
2529 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2530
2531 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2532 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2533 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2534
2535 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2536 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2537 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002538 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2539 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2540 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2541 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2542 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002543
2544 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2545
2546 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2547 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2548 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2549
2550 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002551 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2552 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2553 "info".
2554
2555 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2556 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2557 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2558 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2559
2560 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2561 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002562
2563 Example :
2564 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002565 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2566 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002567
2568
2569maxconn <conns>
2570 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2572 yes | yes | yes | no
2573 Arguments :
2574 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2575 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2576 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2577 closes.
2578
2579 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2580 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2581 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2582 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2583 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2584 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2585 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2586 properly tuned.
2587
2588 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2589 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2590 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2591
2592 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2593
2594
2595mode { tcp|http|health }
2596 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2598 yes | yes | yes | yes
2599 Arguments :
2600 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2601 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2602 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2603 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2604
2605 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2606 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2607 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2608 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2609 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2610
2611 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2612 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2613 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2614 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2615 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2616 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2617
2618 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2619 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2620 will be refused.
2621
2622 Example :
2623 defaults http_instances
2624 mode http
2625
2626 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002629monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002630 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2632 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002633 Arguments :
2634 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2635 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002636 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2638 backend and its backup.
2639
2640 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2641 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2642 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2643 servers in a list of backends.
2644
2645 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2646 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2647 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2648 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2649 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2650 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2651 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002652 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002653
2654 Example:
2655 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002656 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002657 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2658 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2659 monitor-uri /site_alive
2660 monitor fail if site_dead
2661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002662 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri"
2663
2664
2665monitor-net <source>
2666 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2668 yes | yes | yes | no
2669 Arguments :
2670 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2671 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2672 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2673 followed by a mask.
2674
2675 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2676 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002677 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002678 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2679
2680 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2681 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2682 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2683 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2684 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2685
2686 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2687 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2688 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2689 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2690 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2691
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002692 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2693 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2694
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002695 Example :
2696 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2697 frontend www
2698 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2699
2700 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2701
2702
2703monitor-uri <uri>
2704 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2706 yes | yes | yes | no
2707 Arguments :
2708 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2709 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2710
2711 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2712 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2713 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2714 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2715 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2716 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2717 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2718 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2719
2720 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2721 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2722 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2723 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2724 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2725 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2726
2727 Example :
2728 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2729 frontend www
2730 mode http
2731 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2732
2733 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002736option abortonclose
2737no option abortonclose
2738 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2740 yes | no | yes | yes
2741 Arguments : none
2742
2743 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2744 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2745 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2746 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002747 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002748 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2749 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2750 encountered while delivering the response.
2751
2752 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2753 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2754 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2755 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2756 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2757 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002758 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002759 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002760 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002761 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2762 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2763 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2764
2765 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2766 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2767 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2768 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2769 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2770 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2771 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2772 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002773 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002774
2775 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2776 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2777
2778 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2779
2780
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002781option accept-invalid-http-request
2782no option accept-invalid-http-request
2783 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2785 yes | yes | yes | no
2786 Arguments : none
2787
2788 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2789 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2790 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2791 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2792 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2793 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2794 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2795 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2796 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2797
2798 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2799 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2800 been confirmed.
2801
2802 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2803 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2804 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2805 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2806
2807 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2808 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2809
2810 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2811 stats socket.
2812
2813
2814option accept-invalid-http-response
2815no option accept-invalid-http-response
2816 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2818 yes | no | yes | yes
2819 Arguments : none
2820
2821 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2822 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2823 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2824 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2825 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2826 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2827 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2828 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2829 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2830
2831 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2832 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2833 been confirmed.
2834
2835 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2836 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2837 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2838 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2839
2840 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2841 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2842
2843 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2844 stats socket.
2845
2846
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002847option allbackups
2848no option allbackups
2849 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2851 yes | no | yes | yes
2852 Arguments : none
2853
2854 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2855 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2856 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2857 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2858 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2859 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2860 order between the backup servers anymore.
2861
2862 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2863 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2864
2865 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2866 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2867
2868
2869option checkcache
2870no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002871 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2873 yes | no | yes | yes
2874 Arguments : none
2875
2876 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2877 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002878 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002879 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2880 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2881 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2882
2883 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002884 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002885 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002886 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2887 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002888 to the client are :
2889 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002890 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002891 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002892 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2893 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2894 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2895 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2896 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2897 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2898 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2899 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2900 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2901 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2902 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2903
2904 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002905 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002906 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002907 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002908 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2909
2910 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2911 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002912 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002913 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2914
2915 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2916 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2917
2918
2919option clitcpka
2920no option clitcpka
2921 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2923 yes | yes | yes | no
2924 Arguments : none
2925
2926 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2927 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2928 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2929 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2930
2931 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2932 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2933 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2934 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2935
2936 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2937 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2938 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2939 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2940 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2941
2942 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2943
2944 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2945 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2946 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2947
2948 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2949 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2950
2951 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2952
2953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954option contstats
2955 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2957 yes | yes | yes | no
2958 Arguments : none
2959
2960 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2961 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2962 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2963 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2964 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2965 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2966 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2967
2968
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002969option dontlog-normal
2970no option dontlog-normal
2971 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2973 yes | yes | yes | no
2974 Arguments : none
2975
2976 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2977 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2978 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
2979 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
2980 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
2981 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
2982 logged.
2983
2984 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
2985 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
2986 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
2987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002988 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002989 logging.
2990
2991
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002992option dontlognull
2993no option dontlognull
2994 Enable or disable logging of null connections
2995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2996 yes | yes | yes | no
2997 Arguments : none
2998
2999 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3000 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3001 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3002 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3003 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3004 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3005 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3006
3007 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3008 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3009 would not be logged.
3010
3011 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3012 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003014 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003015
3016
3017option forceclose
3018no option forceclose
3019 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003021 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003022 Arguments : none
3023
3024 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3025 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3026 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3027 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3028 global session times in the logs.
3029
3030 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003031 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003032 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3033 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3034 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3035 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003036
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003037 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3038 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3039 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3040
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003041 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3042 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3043
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003044 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003045
3046
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003047option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003048 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3050 yes | yes | yes | yes
3051 Arguments :
3052 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3053 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003054 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003055 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003056
3057 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3058 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3059 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3060 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3061 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3062 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3063 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003064 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3065 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3066 possible that the client has already brought one.
3067
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003068 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003069 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003070 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3071 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003072 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3073 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003074
3075 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3076 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3077 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3078 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3079 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3080 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3081 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3082
3083 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003084 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3085 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3086 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003087
3088 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3089 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3090 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3091 when using this option.
3092
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003093 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003094 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3095 frontend www
3096 mode http
3097 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3098
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003099 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3100 backend www
3101 mode http
3102 option forwardfor header X-Client
3103
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003104 See also : "option httpclose"
3105
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003106
3107option http-pretend-keepalive
3108no option http-pretend-keepalive
3109 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3111 yes | yes | yes | yes
3112 Arguments : none
3113
3114 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3115 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3116 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3117 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3118 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3119 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3120 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3121 consider the response complete.
3122
3123 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3124 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3125 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3126 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3127 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3128 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3129
3130 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3131 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3132 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3133 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3134 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3135 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3136 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3137
3138 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3139 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003140 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3141 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3142 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003143
3144 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3145 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3146
3147 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3148
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003149
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003150option http-server-close
3151no option http-server-close
3152 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3154 yes | yes | yes | yes
3155 Arguments : none
3156
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003157 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3158 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3159 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3160 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3161 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3162 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3163 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3164 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3165 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3166 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3167 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3168 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003169
3170 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3171 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3172 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3173 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003174 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3175 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003176
3177 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3178 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003179 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3180 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3181 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003182
3183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3185
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003186 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3187 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003188
3189
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003190option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003191no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003192 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3194 yes | yes | yes | no
3195 Arguments : none
3196
3197 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3198 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3199 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3200 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3201 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3202 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3203 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3204
3205 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3206 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3207 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3208 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3209 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3210 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3211 request along its whole life.
3212
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003213 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3214 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3215 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3216 front of an existing proxy.
3217
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003218 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3219
3220 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3221 http-server-close".
3222
3223
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003224option httpchk
3225option httpchk <uri>
3226option httpchk <method> <uri>
3227option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3228 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3230 yes | no | yes | yes
3231 Arguments :
3232 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3233 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3234 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3235 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3236 ones.
3237
3238 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3239 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3240 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3241
3242 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3243 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3244 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3245 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3246 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3247
3248 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3249 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3250 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3251 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3252 the lack of any response.
3253
3254 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3255
3256 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3257 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3258 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3259
3260 Examples :
3261 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3262 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3263 backend https_relay
3264 mode tcp
3265 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3266 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3267
3268 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
3269 "http-check" and the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
3270
3271
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003272option httpclose
3273no option httpclose
3274 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3276 yes | yes | yes | yes
3277 Arguments : none
3278
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003279 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3280 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3281 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3282 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3283 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3284 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3285 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003286
3287 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003288 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3289 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3290 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3291 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3292 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3293 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003294
3295 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3296 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3297 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003298 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3299 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003300
3301 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3302 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3303
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003304 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3305 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003306
3307
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003308option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003309 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3311 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003312 Arguments :
3313 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3314 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3315 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3316 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3317 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003318
3319 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3320 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3321 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3322 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3323 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3324 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3325 ports.
3326
3327 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3328
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003329 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3330 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3331 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3332 by default.
3333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003334 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003335
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003336
3337option http_proxy
3338no option http_proxy
3339 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3341 yes | yes | yes | yes
3342 Arguments : none
3343
3344 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3345 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3346 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3347 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3348 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3349
3350 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3351 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3352 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3353 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003354 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003355 be analyzed.
3356
3357 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3358 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3359
3360 Example :
3361 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3362 backend direct_forward
3363 option httpclose
3364 option http_proxy
3365
3366 See also : "option httpclose"
3367
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003368
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003369option independant-streams
3370no option independant-streams
3371 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3373 yes | yes | yes | yes
3374 Arguments : none
3375
3376 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3377 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3378 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3379 receive data or not.
3380
3381 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3382 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3383 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3384 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3385 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3386 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3387 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3388 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3389 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3390 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3391 socket buffers.
3392
3393 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3394 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3395 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3396 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3397 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3398
3399 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3400
3401
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003402option ldap-check
3403 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3405 yes | no | yes | yes
3406 Arguments : none
3407
3408 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3409 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3410 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3411 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3412
3413 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3414 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3415
3416 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3417 configure it.
3418
3419 Example :
3420 option ldap-check
3421
3422 See also : "option httpchk"
3423
3424
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003425option log-health-checks
3426no option log-health-checks
3427 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3429 yes | no | yes | yes
3430 Arguments : none
3431
3432 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3433 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3434 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3435 of additional information is limited.
3436
3437 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3438 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3439
3440 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3441
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003442
3443option log-separate-errors
3444no option log-separate-errors
3445 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3447 yes | yes | yes | no
3448 Arguments : none
3449
3450 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3451 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3452 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3453 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3454 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3455 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3456 provides very important information.
3457
3458 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3459 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3460 error logs.
3461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003462 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003463 logging.
3464
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003465
3466option logasap
3467no option logasap
3468 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3470 yes | yes | yes | no
3471 Arguments : none
3472
3473 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3474 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3475 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3476 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3477 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3478 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3479 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003480 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003481 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3482 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3483
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003484 Examples :
3485 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3486 mode http
3487 option httplog
3488 option logasap
3489 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3490
3491 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3492 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3493 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3494 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003496 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003497 logging.
3498
3499
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003500option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3501 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3503 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003504 Arguments :
3505 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3506 to MySQL server.
3507
3508 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3509 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3510 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3511 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3512 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3513 in the MySQL table, like this :
3514
3515 USE mysql;
3516 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3517 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3518
3519 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3520 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3521 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3522 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3523 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3524 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3525 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3526 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3527 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3528
3529 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3530 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003531
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003532 The check requires MySQL >=4.0, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003533
3534 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3535 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3536 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3537 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3538 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3539 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3540
3541 See also: "option httpchk"
3542
3543
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003544option nolinger
3545no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003546 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003547 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3548 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003549 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003550
3551 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3552 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3553 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3554 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3555 connections.
3556
3557 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3558 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3559 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3560 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3561 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3562 this too.
3563
3564 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3565 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3566 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3567
3568 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3569 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3570 for servers.
3571
3572 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3573 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3574
3575
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003576option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3577 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3579 yes | yes | yes | yes
3580 Arguments :
3581 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3582 matching <network>
3583 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3584 header name.
3585
3586 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3587 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3588 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3589 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3590 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3591 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3592 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3593 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3594 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3595 possible that the client has already brought one.
3596
3597 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3598 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3599 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3600 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3601 header and requires different one.
3602
3603 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3604 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3605 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3606 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3607 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3608 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3609 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3610
3611 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3612 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3613 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3614 both are defined.
3615
3616 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3617 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3618 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3619 when using this option.
3620
3621 Examples :
3622 # Original Destination address
3623 frontend www
3624 mode http
3625 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3626
3627 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3628 backend www
3629 mode http
3630 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3631
3632 See also : "option httpclose"
3633
3634
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003635option persist
3636no option persist
3637 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3638 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3639 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003640 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003641
3642 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3643 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3644 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3645 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3646 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3647 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3648 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3649 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3650 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3651 redirected to another valid server.
3652
3653 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3654 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3655
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003656 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003657
3658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003659option redispatch
3660no option redispatch
3661 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3663 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003664 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003665
3666 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3667 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3668 be able to access the service anymore.
3669
3670 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3671 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3672
3673 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3674 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3675 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003677 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3678 "redisp" keywords.
3679
3680 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3681 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3682
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003683 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003684
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003685
3686option smtpchk
3687option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3688 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3690 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003691 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003692 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3693 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3694 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3695
3696 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3697 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3698 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3699
3700 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3701 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3702 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3703 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3704 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3705 dead server.
3706
3707 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3708 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3709 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3710 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3711
3712 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3713 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3714 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3715 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3716 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3717
3718 Example :
3719 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3720
3721 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3722
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003724option socket-stats
3725no option socket-stats
3726
3727 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3729 yes | yes | yes | no
3730
3731 Arguments : none
3732
3733
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003734option splice-auto
3735no option splice-auto
3736 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3738 yes | yes | yes | yes
3739 Arguments : none
3740
3741 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3742 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3743 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3744 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003745 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003746 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3747 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3748 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3749 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3750
3751 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3752 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3753 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3754 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3755 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3756 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3757 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3758 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3759 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3760 keyword.
3761
3762 Example :
3763 option splice-auto
3764
3765 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3766 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3767
3768 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3769 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3770
3771
3772option splice-request
3773no option splice-request
3774 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3776 yes | yes | yes | yes
3777 Arguments : none
3778
3779 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3780 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3781 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3782 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3783 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3784 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3785
3786 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3787
3788 Example :
3789 option splice-request
3790
3791 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3792 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3793
3794 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3795 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3796
3797
3798option splice-response
3799no option splice-response
3800 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3802 yes | yes | yes | yes
3803 Arguments : none
3804
3805 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3806 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3807 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3808 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3809 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3810 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3811
3812 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3813
3814 Example :
3815 option splice-response
3816
3817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3819
3820 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3821 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3822
3823
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003824option srvtcpka
3825no option srvtcpka
3826 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3828 yes | no | yes | yes
3829 Arguments : none
3830
3831 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3832 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3833 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3834 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3835
3836 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3837 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3838 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3839 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3840
3841 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3842 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3843 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3844 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3845 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3846
3847 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3848
3849 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3850 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3851 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3852
3853 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3854 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3855
3856 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3857
3858
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003859option ssl-hello-chk
3860 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3862 yes | no | yes | yes
3863 Arguments : none
3864
3865 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3866 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3867 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3868 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3869 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3870 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3871 hello message.
3872
3873 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3874 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3875 messages, which is appreciable.
3876
3877 See also: "option httpchk"
3878
3879
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003880option tcp-smart-accept
3881no option tcp-smart-accept
3882 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3884 yes | yes | yes | no
3885 Arguments : none
3886
3887 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3888 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3889 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3890 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3891 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3892 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3893
3894 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3895 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3896 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3897 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3898
3899 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3900 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3901 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3902 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3903
3904 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3905 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3906 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3907
3908 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3909 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3910 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3911
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003912 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3913
3914
3915option tcp-smart-connect
3916no option tcp-smart-connect
3917 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3919 yes | no | yes | yes
3920 Arguments : none
3921
3922 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3923 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3924 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3925 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3926 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3927
3928 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3929 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3930 complex.
3931
3932 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
3933 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
3934 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
3935
3936 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3937 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3938
3939 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
3940
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003941
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003942option tcpka
3943 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
3944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3945 yes | yes | yes | yes
3946 Arguments : none
3947
3948 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3949 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3950 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3951 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3952
3953 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3954 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3955 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3956 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3957
3958 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3959 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3960 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3961 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3962 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3963
3964 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3965
3966 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
3967 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
3968 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
3969 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
3970 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
3971 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
3972 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
3973 backends.
3974
3975 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
3976
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003977
3978option tcplog
3979 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
3980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3981 yes | yes | yes | yes
3982 Arguments : none
3983
3984 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3985 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3986 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
3987 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
3988 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
3989 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
3990 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
3991 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
3992
3993 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003995 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003996
3997
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003998option transparent
3999no option transparent
4000 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004002 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004003 Arguments : none
4004
4005 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4006 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4007 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4008 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4009 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4010 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4011 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4012 appropriate server.
4013
4014 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4015 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4016
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004017 See also: the "usersrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
4018 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004019
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004020
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004021persist rdp-cookie
4022persist rdp-cookie(name)
4023 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | no | yes | yes
4026 Arguments :
4027 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004028 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4029 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004030
4031 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4032 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4033 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4034 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4035 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4036 forwarded to this server.
4037
4038 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4039 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4040 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004041 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004042 a single "listen" section.
4043
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004044 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4045 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4046 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4047
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004048 Example :
4049 listen tse-farm
4050 bind :3389
4051 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4052 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4053 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4054 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4055 persist rdp-cookie
4056 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4057 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4058 balance rdp-cookie
4059 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4060 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4061
4062 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
4063
4064
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004065rate-limit sessions <rate>
4066 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4068 yes | yes | yes | no
4069 Arguments :
4070 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4071 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4072
4073 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4074 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4075 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4076 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4077 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4078 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4079
4080 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4081 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4082 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4083 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4084
4085 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4086 listen smtp
4087 mode tcp
4088 bind :25
4089 rate-limit sessions 10
4090 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4091
4092 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
4093 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
4094
4095 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4096
4097
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004098redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4099redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004100 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4102 no | yes | yes | yes
4103
4104 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004105 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004106
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004107 Arguments :
4108 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4109 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4110 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4111 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004112 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4113 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4114 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4115 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004116
4117 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4118 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4119 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4120 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4121 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4122 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4123 location with a GET method.
4124
4125 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4126 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4127
4128 - "drop-query"
4129 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4130 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4131 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4132 with a location-type redirect.
4133
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004134 - "append-slash"
4135 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4136 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4137 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4138 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4139
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004140 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4141 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4142 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4143 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4144 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4145 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4146 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4147
4148 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4149 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4150 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4151 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4152 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4153 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4154 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004155
4156 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4157 acl clear dst_port 80
4158 acl secure dst_port 8080
4159 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004160 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004161 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004162 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4163
4164 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004165 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4166 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4167 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004168 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004169
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004170 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4171 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4172 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004174 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004175
4176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004177redisp (deprecated)
4178redispatch (deprecated)
4179 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4180 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4181 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004182 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004183
4184 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4185 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4186 be able to access the service anymore.
4187
4188 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4189 redistribute them to a working server.
4190
4191 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4192 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4193 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004195 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4196 "option redispatch" instead.
4197
4198 See also : "option redispatch"
4199
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004200
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004201reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004202 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4204 no | yes | yes | yes
4205 Arguments :
4206 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4207 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004208 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004209
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004210 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4211 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4212
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004213 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4214 the last header of an HTTP request.
4215
4216 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4217 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4218 responses.
4219
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004220 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4221 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4222 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4223
4224 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4225 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004226
4227
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004228reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4229reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004230 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4232 no | yes | yes | yes
4233 Arguments :
4234 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4235 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4236 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4237 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4238 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4239 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4240 ignores case.
4241
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004242 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4243 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4244
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004245 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4246 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4247 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4248 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004249 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004250
4251 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4252 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4253
4254 Example :
4255 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4256 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4257 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4258
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004259 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4260 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004261
4262
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004263reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4264reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004265 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4267 no | yes | yes | yes
4268 Arguments :
4269 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4270 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4271 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4272 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4273 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4274 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4275
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004276 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4277 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4278
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004279 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4280 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4281 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4282 next servers.
4283
4284 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4285 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4286 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4287
4288 Example :
4289 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4290 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4291 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4292
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004293 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4294 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004295
4296
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004297reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4298reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004299 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4301 no | yes | yes | yes
4302 Arguments :
4303 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4304 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4305 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4306 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4307 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4308 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4309 case.
4310
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004311 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4312 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4313
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004314 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4315 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4316 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4317 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004318 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004319
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004320 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004321 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004322 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004323
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004324 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4325 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4326
4327 Example :
4328 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4329 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4330 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4331
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004332 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4333 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004334
4335
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004336reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4337reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004338 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4340 no | yes | yes | yes
4341 Arguments :
4342 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4343 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4344 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4345 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4346 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4347 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4348 case.
4349
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004350 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4351 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4352
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004353 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4354 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4355 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4356 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4357
4358 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4359 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4360
4361 Example :
4362 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4363 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4364 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4365 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4366
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004367 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4368 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004369
4370
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004371reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4372reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004373 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4375 no | yes | yes | yes
4376 Arguments :
4377 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4378 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4379 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4380 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4381 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4382 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4383
4384 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4385 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4386 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4387 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004388 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004389
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004390 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4391 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4392
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004393 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4394 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4395 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4396
4397 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4398 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4399 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4400 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4401 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4402
4403 Example :
4404 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4405 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4406 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4407 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4408
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004409 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4410 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004411
4412
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004413reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4414reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004415 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4417 no | yes | yes | yes
4418 Arguments :
4419 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4420 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4421 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4422 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4423 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4424 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4425 ignores case.
4426
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004427 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4428 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4429
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004430 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4431 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004432 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4433 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4434 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004435 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4436 not set.
4437
4438 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4439 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4440 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4441 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4442 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4443
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004444 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004445 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4446 # block all others.
4447 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4448 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4449
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004450 # block bad guys
4451 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4452 reqitarpit . if badguys
4453
4454 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4455 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004456
4457
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004458retries <value>
4459 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4460 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4461 yes | no | yes | yes
4462 Arguments :
4463 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4464 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4465 default value is 3.
4466
4467 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4468 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4469 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4470
4471 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4472 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4473
4474 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4475 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4476
4477 See also : "option redispatch"
4478
4479
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004480rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004481 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4483 no | yes | yes | yes
4484 Arguments :
4485 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4486 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004487 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004488
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004489 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4490 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4491
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004492 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4493 the last header of an HTTP response.
4494
4495 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4496 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4497 responses.
4498
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004499 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4500 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004501
4502
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004503rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4504rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004505 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4507 no | yes | yes | yes
4508 Arguments :
4509 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4510 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4511 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4512 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4513 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4514 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4515 ignores case.
4516
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004517 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4518 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4519
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004520 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4521 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4522 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4523 client.
4524
4525 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4526 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4527 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4528
4529 Example :
4530 # remove the Server header from responses
4531 reqidel ^Server:.*
4532
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004533 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4534 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004535
4536
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004537rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4538rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004539 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4541 no | yes | yes | yes
4542 Arguments :
4543 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4544 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4545 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4546 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4547 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4548 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4549 ignores case.
4550
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004551 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4552 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4553
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004554 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4555 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4556 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4557 case-sensitive.
4558
4559 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004560 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4561 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4562 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004563
4564 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4565 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4566
4567 Example :
4568 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4569 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4570
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004571 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4572 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004573
4574
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004575rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4576rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004577 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4579 no | yes | yes | yes
4580 Arguments :
4581 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4582 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4583 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4584 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4585 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4586 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4587 ignores case.
4588
4589 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4590 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4591 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4592 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004593 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004594
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004595 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4596 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4597
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004598 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4599 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4600 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4601
4602 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4603 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4604 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4605 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4606 are not case-sensitive.
4607
4608 Example :
4609 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4610 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4611
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004612 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4613 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004614
4615
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004616server <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
4617 Declare a server in a backend
4618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4619 no | no | yes | yes
4620 Arguments :
4621 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4622 appear in logs and alerts.
4623
4624 <address> is the IPv4 address of the server. Alternatively, a resolvable
4625 hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved during
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004626 start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning. It
4627 indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
4628 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4629 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4630 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4631 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4632 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4633 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004634
4635 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4636 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4637 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4638 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4639 adding this value to the client's port.
4640
4641 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4642 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004643 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004644
4645 Examples :
4646 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4647 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004649 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004650
4651
4652source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004653source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004654source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004655 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4657 yes | no | yes | yes
4658 Arguments :
4659 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4660 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4661 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4662 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4663
4664 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4665 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004666 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4667 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4668 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004669
4670 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4671 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4672 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4673 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4674 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4675 <addr>.
4676
4677 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4678 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4679 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4680 port.
4681
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004682 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4683 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4684 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4685 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4686 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4687 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4688 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4689 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4690 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4691 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4692 HTTP header.
4693
4694 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4695 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4696 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4697 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4698 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4699 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4700 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4701 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4702 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4703 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4704
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004705 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4706 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4707 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4708 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4709 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4710 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4711
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004712 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4713 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4714 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4715 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4716
4717 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4718 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4719 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4720 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4721 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4722 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4723
4724 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4725 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4726 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4727 there are two methods :
4728
4729 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4730 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4731 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4732 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4733 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4734 of the client ranges may be used.
4735
4736 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4737 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4738 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4739 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4740 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4741 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4742 same session.
4743
4744 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4745 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4746 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4747 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4748 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4749 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4750
4751 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4752 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4753 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004754 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004755
4756 Examples :
4757 backend private
4758 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4759 source 192.168.1.200
4760
4761 backend transparent_ssl1
4762 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4763 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4764
4765 backend transparent_ssl2
4766 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4767 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4768 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4769
4770 backend transparent_ssl3
4771 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4772 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4773 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4774
4775 backend transparent_smtp
4776 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4777 # with Tproxy version 4.
4778 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4779
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004780 backend transparent_http
4781 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4782 # proxy.
4783 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004785 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004786 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004788
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004789srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4790 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4792 yes | no | yes | yes
4793 Arguments :
4794 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4795 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4796 as explained at the top of this document.
4797
4798 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4799 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4800 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4801 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4802 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4803 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4804 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4805
4806 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4807 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4808 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4809 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4810 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004811 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004812 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004813 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004814
4815 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4816 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4817 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4818 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4819 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4820 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4821
4822 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4823 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4824
4825 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4826
4827
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004828stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4829 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4831 no | no | yes | yes
4832
4833 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4834 matched.
4835
4836 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4837 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4838
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004839 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4840 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4841 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4842
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004843 Currently, there are 2 known limitations :
4844
4845 - The POST data are limited to one packet, which means that if the list of
4846 servers is too long, the request won't be processed. It is recommended
4847 to alter few servers at a time.
4848
4849 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported.
4850
4851 Example :
4852 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4853 backend stats_localhost
4854 stats enable
4855 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4856
4857 Example :
4858 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4859 backend stats_auth
4860 stats enable
4861 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4862 stats admin if TRUE
4863
4864 Example :
4865 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4866 userlist stats-auth
4867 group admin users admin
4868 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4869 group readonly users haproxy
4870 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4871
4872 backend stats_auth
4873 stats enable
4874 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4875 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4876 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4877 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4878
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004879 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
4880 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4881 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004882
4883
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004884stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4885 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4887 yes | no | yes | yes
4888 Arguments :
4889 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4890
4891 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4892
4893 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4894 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4895 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4896 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4897 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4898 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4899
4900 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4901 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4902 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4903 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4904
4905 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4906 report using "stats scope".
4907
4908 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4909 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4910 unobvious parameters.
4911
4912 Example :
4913 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4914 backend public_www
4915 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4916 stats enable
4917 stats hide-version
4918 stats scope .
4919 stats uri /admin?stats
4920 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4921 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4922 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4923
4924 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4925 backend private_monitoring
4926 stats enable
4927 stats uri /admin?stats
4928 stats refresh 5s
4929
4930 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4931
4932
4933stats enable
4934 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
4935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4936 yes | no | yes | yes
4937 Arguments : none
4938
4939 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
4940 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
4941 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
4942 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
4943 - stats auth : no authentication
4944 - stats scope : no restriction
4945
4946 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4947 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4948 unobvious parameters.
4949
4950 Example :
4951 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4952 backend public_www
4953 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4954 stats enable
4955 stats hide-version
4956 stats scope .
4957 stats uri /admin?stats
4958 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4959 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4960 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4961
4962 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4963 backend private_monitoring
4964 stats enable
4965 stats uri /admin?stats
4966 stats refresh 5s
4967
4968 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4969
4970
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004971stats hide-version
4972 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4974 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004975 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004976
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004977 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
4978 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
4979 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
4980 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
4981 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
4982 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004984 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4985 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4986 unobvious parameters.
4987
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004988 Example :
4989 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4990 backend public_www
4991 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004992 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004993 stats hide-version
4994 stats scope .
4995 stats uri /admin?stats
4996 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4997 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4998 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004999
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005000 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5001 backend private_monitoring
5002 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005003 stats uri /admin?stats
5004 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005005
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005006 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005007
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005008
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005009stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5010 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5011 Access control for statistics
5012
5013 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5014 no | no | yes | yes
5015
5016 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5017 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5018 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5019 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5020 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5021 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5022
5023 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5024 instance.
5025
5026 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5027 about ACL usage.
5028
5029
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005030stats realm <realm>
5031 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5033 yes | no | yes | yes
5034 Arguments :
5035 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5036 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5037 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5038
5039 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5040 using a backslash ('\').
5041
5042 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5043 only related to authentication.
5044
5045 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5046 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5047 unobvious parameters.
5048
5049 Example :
5050 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5051 backend public_www
5052 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5053 stats enable
5054 stats hide-version
5055 stats scope .
5056 stats uri /admin?stats
5057 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5058 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5059 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5060
5061 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5062 backend private_monitoring
5063 stats enable
5064 stats uri /admin?stats
5065 stats refresh 5s
5066
5067 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5068
5069
5070stats refresh <delay>
5071 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5073 yes | no | yes | yes
5074 Arguments :
5075 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5076 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5077 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5078 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5079 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5080 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5081
5082 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5083 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5084 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5085 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5086
5087 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5088 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5089 unobvious parameters.
5090
5091 Example :
5092 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5093 backend public_www
5094 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5095 stats enable
5096 stats hide-version
5097 stats scope .
5098 stats uri /admin?stats
5099 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5100 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5101 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5102
5103 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5104 backend private_monitoring
5105 stats enable
5106 stats uri /admin?stats
5107 stats refresh 5s
5108
5109 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5110
5111
5112stats scope { <name> | "." }
5113 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5115 yes | no | yes | yes
5116 Arguments :
5117 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5118 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5119 section in which the statement appears.
5120
5121 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5122 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5123 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5124 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5125 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5126 exists.
5127
5128 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5129 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5130 unobvious parameters.
5131
5132 Example :
5133 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5134 backend public_www
5135 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5136 stats enable
5137 stats hide-version
5138 stats scope .
5139 stats uri /admin?stats
5140 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5141 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5142 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5143
5144 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5145 backend private_monitoring
5146 stats enable
5147 stats uri /admin?stats
5148 stats refresh 5s
5149
5150 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5151
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005152
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005153stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005154 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5156 yes | no | yes | yes
5157
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005158 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005159 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5160
5161 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5162 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5163
5164 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5165 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5166 unobvious parameters.
5167
5168 Example :
5169 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5170 backend private_monitoring
5171 stats enable
5172 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5173 stats uri /admin?stats
5174 stats refresh 5s
5175
5176 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5177 global section.
5178
5179
5180stats show-legends
5181 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5182 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5183 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5184 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5185 - IP (socket, server)
5186 - cookie (backend, server)
5187
5188 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5189 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5190 unobvious parameters.
5191
5192 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5193
5194
5195stats show-node [ <name> ]
5196 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5198 yes | no | yes | yes
5199 Arguments:
5200 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5201 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5202
5203 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5204 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5205 provided for each customer.
5206
5207 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5208 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5209 unobvious parameters.
5210
5211 Example:
5212 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5213 backend private_monitoring
5214 stats enable
5215 stats show-node Europe-1
5216 stats uri /admin?stats
5217 stats refresh 5s
5218
5219 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5220 section.
5221
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005222
5223stats uri <prefix>
5224 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5226 yes | no | yes | yes
5227 Arguments :
5228 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5229 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5230 query string.
5231
5232 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5233 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5234 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5235 possible to reach it in the application.
5236
5237 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005238 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005239 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5240 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5241 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5242 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5243
5244 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5245 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5246 an address or a port to statistics only.
5247
5248 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5249 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5250 unobvious parameters.
5251
5252 Example :
5253 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5254 backend public_www
5255 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5256 stats enable
5257 stats hide-version
5258 stats scope .
5259 stats uri /admin?stats
5260 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5261 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5262 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5263
5264 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5265 backend private_monitoring
5266 stats enable
5267 stats uri /admin?stats
5268 stats refresh 5s
5269
5270 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5271
5272
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005273stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5274 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005276 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005277
5278 Arguments :
5279 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5280 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5281 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5282 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5283
5284 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5285 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5286 the "stick-table" statement.
5287
5288 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5289 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5290 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5291 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5292 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5293
5294 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5295 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5296 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5297 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5298 transformation rules.
5299
5300 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5301 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5302 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5303 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5304 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5305 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5306 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5307
5308 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5309 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5310 ACL based conditions.
5311
5312 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5313 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5314 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5315 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5316
5317 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5318 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5319 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5320 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5321
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005322 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5323 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5324 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5325
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005326 Example :
5327 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5328 # last 30 minutes
5329 backend pop
5330 mode tcp
5331 balance roundrobin
5332 stick store-request src
5333 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5334 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5335 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5336
5337 backend smtp
5338 mode tcp
5339 balance roundrobin
5340 stick match src table pop
5341 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5342 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5343
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005344 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5345 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005346
5347
5348stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5349 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5351 no | no | yes | yes
5352
5353 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5354 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5355 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5356 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5357
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005358 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5359 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5360 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5361
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005362 Examples :
5363 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005364 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005365
5366 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5367 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5368 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5369
5370
5371 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5372 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5373 backend http
5374 mode http
5375 balance roundrobin
5376 stick on src table https
5377 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5378 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5379 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5380
5381 backend https
5382 mode tcp
5383 balance roundrobin
5384 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5385 stick on src
5386 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5387 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5388
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005389 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005390
5391
5392stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5393 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5395 no | no | yes | yes
5396
5397 Arguments :
5398 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5399 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5400 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5401 server is selected.
5402
5403 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5404 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5405 the "stick-table" statement.
5406
5407 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5408 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5409 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5410 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5411 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5412 address.
5413
5414 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5415 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5416 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5417 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5418 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5419 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5420 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5421 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5422 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5423 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5424
5425 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5426 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5427 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5428 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5429 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5430 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5431 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5432
5433 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5434 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5435 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5436 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5437
5438 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5439 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5440 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5441 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5442 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5443 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5444 another protocol or access method.
5445
5446 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5447 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5448 the request.
5449
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005450 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5451 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5452 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5453
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005454 Example :
5455 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5456 # last 30 minutes
5457 backend pop
5458 mode tcp
5459 balance roundrobin
5460 stick store-request src
5461 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5462 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5463 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5464
5465 backend smtp
5466 mode tcp
5467 balance roundrobin
5468 stick match src table pop
5469 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5470 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5471
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005472 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5473 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005474
5475
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005476stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005477 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5478 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005479 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005481 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005482
5483 Arguments :
5484 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5485 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5486 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5487 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5488
5489 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5490 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5491 instance.
5492
5493 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5494 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5495 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5496 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5497 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5498 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005499 to 32 characters.
5500
5501 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5502 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5503 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5504 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5505 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5506 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005507
5508 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005509 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5510 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005511 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5512 increase.
5513
5514 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005515 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5516 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5517 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005518
5519 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5520 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5521 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5522 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5523 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5524 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5525 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5526 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5527 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5528 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5529 parameter (see below).
5530
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005531 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5532 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5533 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5534 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5535 soft restart.
5536
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005537 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5538
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005539 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5540 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5541 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5542 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5543 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5544 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5545 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5546 if not expiration delay is specified.
5547
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005548 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5549 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5550 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5551 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005552 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5553 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5554 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5555 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5556 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5557 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5558 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5559 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5560 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5561 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5562 types and their arguments.
5563
5564 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5565 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5566 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5567 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5568
5569 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5570 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5571 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5572 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5573
5574 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5575 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5576 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5577 they were received.
5578
5579 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5580 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5581 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5582 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5583 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5584
5585 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5586 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5587 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5588 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5589 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5590
5591 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5592 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5593 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5594
5595 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5596 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5597 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5598 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5599 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5600
5601 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5602 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5603 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5604 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5605 the client side.
5606
5607 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5608 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5609 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5610 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5611 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5612 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5613 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5614
5615 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5616 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5617 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5618 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5619 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5620 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5621 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5622
5623 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5624 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5625 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5626 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5627 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5628 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5629
5630 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5631 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5632 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5633 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5634
5635 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5636 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5637 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5638 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5639 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5640 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5641 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5642 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5643 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5644 recommended for better fairness.
5645
5646 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5647 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5648 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5649 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5650
5651 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5652 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5653 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5654 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5655 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5656 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5657 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5658 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5659 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5660 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005661
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005662 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5663 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005664 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5665 reference it.
5666
5667 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5668 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5669 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5670 as an exclusive stickiness.
5671
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005672 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5673 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5674 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5675 something that can be ignored.
5676
5677 Example:
5678 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5679 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5680 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5681 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5682
5683 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
5684 about time format and section 7 avoud ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005685
5686
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005687stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5688 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5690 no | no | yes | yes
5691
5692 Arguments :
5693 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5694 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5695 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5696 server is selected.
5697
5698 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5699 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5700 the "stick-table" statement.
5701
5702 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5703 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5704 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5705 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5706
5707 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5708 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5709 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5710 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5711 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5712 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5713 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5714 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5715 rules.
5716
5717 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5718 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5719 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5720 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5721 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5722 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5723 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5724
5725 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5726 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5727 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5728 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5729
5730 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5731 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5732 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5733 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5734 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5735 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5736 another protocol or access method.
5737
5738 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5739
5740 Example :
5741 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5742 backend https
5743 mode tcp
5744 balance roundrobin
5745 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5746 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5747
5748 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5749 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5750
5751 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5752 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5753 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5754
5755 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5756 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5757
5758 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5759 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5760 # at offset 44.
5761
5762 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5763 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5764
5765 # Learn on response if server hello.
5766 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5767
5768 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5769 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5770
5771 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5772 extraction.
5773
5774
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005775tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5776 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5778 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005779 Arguments :
5780 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5781 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5782 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005783
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005784 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005785
5786 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5787 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005788 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5789 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5790 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5791 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5792 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5793 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005794
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005795 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5796 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5797 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5798 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005799
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005800 Three types of actions are supported :
5801 - accept :
5802 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5803 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5804 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005805
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005806 - reject :
5807 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5808 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5809 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5810 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5811 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5812 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5813 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5814 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5815 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5816 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5817 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5818 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005819
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005820 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5821 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5822 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5823 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5824 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5825 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5826 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5827 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5828 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005829
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005830 These actions take one or two arguments :
5831 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5832 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5833 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005834
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005835 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5836 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5837 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5838 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005839
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005840 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5841 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5842 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5843 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5844 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5845 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5846 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5847 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5848 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5849 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005850
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005851 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5852 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5853 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005854
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005855 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5856 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5857 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005858
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005859 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005860 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005861 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005862
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005863 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5864 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5865 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005866
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005867 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5868 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5869 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005870
5871 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5872
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005873 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005874
5875
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005876tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5877 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005879 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005880 Arguments :
5881 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5882 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5883 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005884
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005885 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005886
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005887 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5888 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5889 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5890 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5891 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005892
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005893 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5894 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5895 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5896 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5897 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5898 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5899 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5900 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5901 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005902
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005903 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5904 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5905 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5906 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005907
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005908 Three types of actions are supported :
5909 - accept :
5910 - reject :
5911 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005912
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005913 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5914 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005916 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5917 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5918 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5919 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5920 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5921 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005923 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005924 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5925 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005927 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5928 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5929 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
5930 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
5931 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005932
5933 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005934 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
5935 # and reject everything else.
5936 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
5937 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5938 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
5939 tcp-request content reject
5940
5941 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005942 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
5943 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5944 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005945 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005946
5947 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
5948 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5949 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005950 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005951 tcp-request content reject
5952
5953 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
5954 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
5955
5956 frontend http
5957 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
5958 # protecting all our sites
5959 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
5960 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5961 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
5962 ...
5963 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
5964
5965 backend http_dynamic
5966 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
5967 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
5968 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
5969 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
5970 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
5971 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
5972 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005974 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005975
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005976 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005977
5978
5979tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
5980 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
5981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005982 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005983 Arguments :
5984 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5985 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5986 as explained at the top of this document.
5987
5988 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
5989 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
5990 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
5991 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
5992 data for at most the specified amount of time.
5993
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005994 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
5995 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
5996 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
5997 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
5998
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005999 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6000 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006001 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006002 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006003 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6004 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6005 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6006 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006007
6008 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6009 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6010 it pass through unaffected.
6011
6012 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6013 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6014 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006015 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006016 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6017 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006018 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6019 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6020 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006021
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006022 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006023 "timeout client".
6024
6025
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006026tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6027 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6029 no | no | yes | yes
6030 Arguments :
6031 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6032 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6033 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6034
6035 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6036
6037 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6038 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6039 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6040 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6041 set and expires with no matching rule.
6042
6043 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6044
6045 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6046 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6047 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6048 inserted.
6049
6050 Two types of actions are supported :
6051 - accept :
6052 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6053 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6054 the rules evaluation.
6055
6056 - reject :
6057 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6058 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6059 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6060
6061 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6062 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6063 for changing the default action to a reject.
6064
6065 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6066 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6067 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6068 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6069 period.
6070
6071 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6072
6073 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6074
6075
6076tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6077 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6079 no | no | yes | yes
6080 Arguments :
6081 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6082 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6083 as explained at the top of this document.
6084
6085 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6086
6087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006088timeout check <timeout>
6089 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6090 established.
6091
6092 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6093 yes | no | yes | yes
6094 Arguments:
6095 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6096 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6097 as explained at the top of this document.
6098
6099 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6100 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6101 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6102 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006103 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6104 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6105 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006106
6107 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6108 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6109
6110 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6111 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006112 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006113
6114 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6115 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6116 forget about it.
6117
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006118 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6119 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006120
6121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006122timeout client <timeout>
6123timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6124 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6126 yes | yes | yes | no
6127 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006128 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006129 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6130 as explained at the top of this document.
6131
6132 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6133 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6134 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6135 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6136 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6137 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6138 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6139 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006140 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006141 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6142 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6143
6144 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6145 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6146 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6147 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6148 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6149 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6150
6151 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6152 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6153 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6154
6155 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6156
6157
6158timeout connect <timeout>
6159timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6160 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6162 yes | no | yes | yes
6163 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006164 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006165 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6166 as explained at the top of this document.
6167
6168 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006169 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006170 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006171 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006172 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6173 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006174
6175 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6176 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6177 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6178 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6179 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6180 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6181
6182 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6183 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6184 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6185
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006186 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6187 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006188
6189
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006190timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6191 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6193 yes | yes | yes | yes
6194 Arguments :
6195 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6196 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6197 as explained at the top of this document.
6198
6199 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6200 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6201 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6202 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6203 once the request has started to present itself.
6204
6205 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6206 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6207 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6208 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6209 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6210
6211 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6212 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6213 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6214 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6215
6216 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6217 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6218 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6219 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6220 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006221 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006222
6223 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6224 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6225 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6226 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6227
6228 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6229
6230
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006231timeout http-request <timeout>
6232 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006234 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006235 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006236 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006237 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6238 as explained at the top of this document.
6239
6240 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6241 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6242 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6243 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6244 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6245 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6246 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6247 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6248
6249 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6250 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006251 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6252 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006253
6254 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6255 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6256 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6257 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6258 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6259
6260 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006261 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6262 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6263 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006264
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006265 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006266
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006267
6268timeout queue <timeout>
6269 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6271 yes | no | yes | yes
6272 Arguments :
6273 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6274 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6275 as explained at the top of this document.
6276
6277 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6278 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6279 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6280 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6281 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6282
6283 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6284 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6285 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6286 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6287
6288 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6289
6290
6291timeout server <timeout>
6292timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6293 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6295 yes | no | yes | yes
6296 Arguments :
6297 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6298 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6299 as explained at the top of this document.
6300
6301 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6302 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6303 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6304 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6305 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6306 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6307 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6308
6309 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6310 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6311 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6312 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6313 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006314 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006315 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006316 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006317
6318 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6319 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6320 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6321 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6322 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6323 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6324
6325 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6326 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6327 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6328
6329 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6330
6331
6332timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006333 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6335 yes | yes | yes | yes
6336 Arguments :
6337 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6338 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6339 as explained at the top of this document.
6340
6341 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6342 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6343 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6344
6345 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6346 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6347 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6348 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006349 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006350
6351 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6352
6353
6354transparent (deprecated)
6355 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006357 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006358 Arguments : none
6359
6360 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6361 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6362 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6363 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6364 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6365 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6366 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6367 appropriate server.
6368
6369 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6370
6371 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6372 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6373
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006374 See also: "option transparent"
6375
6376
6377use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6378use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006379 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6381 no | yes | yes | no
6382 Arguments :
6383 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006385 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006386
6387 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6388 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6389 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006390 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6391 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6392 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6393 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006394
6395 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6396 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6397 assign the backend.
6398
6399 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6400 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6401 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6402 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6403 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6404 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6405
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006406 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006407 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006408 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6409 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6410 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6411
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006412 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006413
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006414
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010064155. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006416------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006418The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6419which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6420arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6421settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6422after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6423Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6424address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006426 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006427 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006428
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006429The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006431addr <ipv4>
6432 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6433 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6434 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6435 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6436 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006438 Supported in default-server: No
6439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006440backup
6441 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6442 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6443 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6444 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6445 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6446 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006448 Supported in default-server: No
6449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006450check
6451 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6452 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6453 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6454 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6455 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6456 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6457 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6458 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6459 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006460 "mysql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and
6461 parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006463 Supported in default-server: No
6464
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006465cookie <value>
6466 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6467 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6468 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6469 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6470 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6471 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6472 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6473
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006474 Supported in default-server: No
6475
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006476disabled
6477 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6478 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6479 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6480 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6481 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6482
6483 Supported in default-server: No
6484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006485error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006486 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6487 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6488 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006489
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006490 Supported in default-server: Yes
6491
6492 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006493
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006494fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006495 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6496 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6497 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006499 Supported in default-server: Yes
6500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006501id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006502 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6503 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6504 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006506 Supported in default-server: No
6507
6508inter <delay>
6509fastinter <delay>
6510downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006511 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6512 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6513 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6514 between checks depending on the server state :
6515
6516 Server state | Interval used
6517 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6518 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6519 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6520 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6521 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6522 or yet unchecked. |
6523 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6524 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6525 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006526
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006527 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6528 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6529 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6530 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6531 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6532 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6533 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6534 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6535 servers.
6536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006537 Supported in default-server: Yes
6538
6539maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006540 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6541 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6542 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6543 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6544 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6545 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6546 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6547 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006549 Supported in default-server: Yes
6550
6551maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006552 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6553 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6554 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6555 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6556 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6557 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6558 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006560 Supported in default-server: Yes
6561
6562minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006563 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6564 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6565 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6566 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6567 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6568 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006569 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006570 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006572 Supported in default-server: Yes
6573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006574observe <mode>
6575 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6576 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6577 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6578 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6579 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6580 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6581 headers, a timeout, etc.
6582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006583 Supported in default-server: No
6584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006585 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006587on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006588 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6589 Currently, four modes are available:
6590 - fastinter: force fastinter
6591 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6592 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6593 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6594 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006596 Supported in default-server: Yes
6597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006598 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006600port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006601 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6602 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6603 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6604 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6605 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6606 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006608 Supported in default-server: Yes
6609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006610redir <prefix>
6611 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6612 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6613 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6614 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6615 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6616 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6617 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6618 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006619 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006620 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6621 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6622 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6623 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6624 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6625
6626 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006628 Supported in default-server: No
6629
6630rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006631 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6632 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6633 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6634
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006635 Supported in default-server: Yes
6636
6637slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006638 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6639 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6640 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6641 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6642 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6643 parameters :
6644
6645 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6646 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6647
6648 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6649 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6650 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6651 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6652
6653 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6654 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6655 seen as failed.
6656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006657 Supported in default-server: Yes
6658
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006659source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006660source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006661source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006662 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6663 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6664 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6665 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6666
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006667 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6668 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6669 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6670 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6671 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6672 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6673 server.
6674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006675 Supported in default-server: No
6676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006677track [<proxy>/]<server>
6678 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6679 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6680 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6681 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6682 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006684 Supported in default-server: No
6685
6686weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006687 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6688 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6689 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006690 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6691 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6692 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6693 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6694 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6695 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006697 Supported in default-server: Yes
6698
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006699
67006. HTTP header manipulation
6701---------------------------
6702
6703In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6704response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6705request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6706which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6707against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6708to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6709passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6710headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6711never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6712
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006713There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6714(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6715rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6716messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6717in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006718happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006719add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6720normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006722This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6723in section 4.2 :
6724
6725 - reqadd <string>
6726 - reqallow <search>
6727 - reqiallow <search>
6728 - reqdel <search>
6729 - reqidel <search>
6730 - reqdeny <search>
6731 - reqideny <search>
6732 - reqpass <search>
6733 - reqipass <search>
6734 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6735 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6736 - reqtarpit <search>
6737 - reqitarpit <search>
6738 - rspadd <string>
6739 - rspdel <search>
6740 - rspidel <search>
6741 - rspdeny <search>
6742 - rspideny <search>
6743 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6744 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6745
6746With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6747is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6748parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6749prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6750Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6751
6752 \t for a tab
6753 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6754 \n for a new line (LF)
6755 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6756 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6757 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6758 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6759 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6760
6761The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6762portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6763above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6764regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
67659 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6766is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6767
6768The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6769after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6770
6771Notes related to these keywords :
6772---------------------------------
6773 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6774 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6775 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6776
6777 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6778 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6779 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6780
6781 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6782 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6783 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6784 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6785 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6786
6787 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6788 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6789 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6790 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6791 useless headers before adding new ones.
6792
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006793 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006794 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6795
6796 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6797 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6798 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6799
6800 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6801 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006802 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006803
6804
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010068057. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6806------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006807
6808The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6809content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6810from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6811simple :
6812
6813 - define test criteria with sets of values
6814 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6815
6816The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6817
6818In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6819
6820 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6821
6822This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6823Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6824and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6825an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6826of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6827
6828ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6829'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6830which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6831
6832There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6833performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6834
6835The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6836
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006837 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6838 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006839 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6840
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006841The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6842specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6843possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006844multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6845be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6846needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6847space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6848match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6849lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6850duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6851to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6852instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006853
6854 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6855
6856In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6857the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6858case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6859too.
6860
6861Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6862a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6863ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6864
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006865Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006866
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006867 - integers or integer ranges
6868 - strings
6869 - regular expressions
6870 - IP addresses and networks
6871
6872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068737.1. Matching integers
6874----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006875
6876Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6877that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6878expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6879may be omitted.
6880
6881For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6882unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6883representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6884
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006885As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6886two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6887instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6888ranges and operators.
6889
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006890For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006891operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6892Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6893of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006894
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006895Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006896
6897 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6898 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6899 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6900 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6901 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6902
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006903For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006904
6905 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
6906
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006907This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
6908
6909 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
6910
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069127.2. Matching strings
6913---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006914
6915String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
6916exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
6917characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
6918string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
6919to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006920before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006921
6922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069237.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
6924-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006925
6926Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
6927they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
6928possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
6929passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
6930the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006931the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
6932match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006933
6934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069357.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
6936----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006937
6938IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
6939netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
6940within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006941host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006942difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
6943at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
6944does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
6945parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006946
6947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069487.5. Available matching criteria
6949--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069517.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
6952------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006953
6954A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
6955analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
6956addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
6957
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006958always_false
6959 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6960 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6961
6962always_true
6963 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6964 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6965
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006966avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006967avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006968 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
6969 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
6970 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
6971 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
6972 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
6973 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
6974 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
6975 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
6976 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
6977 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
6978 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01006979
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006980be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006981be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006982 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
6983 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
6984 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6985 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
6986 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006987
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01006988be_id <integer>
6989 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
6990 backend it was called.
6991
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006992be_sess_rate <integer>
6993be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
6994 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
6995 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
6996 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
6997 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
6998 sucking of an online dictionary).
6999
7000 Example :
7001 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7002 backend dynamic
7003 mode http
7004 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7005 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007006
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007007connslots <integer>
7008connslots(backend) <integer>
7009 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007010 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007011 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7012
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007013 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7014 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007015
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007016 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007017 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7018 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7019 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7020 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7021 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007022 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007023
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007024 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7025 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7026 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7027 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007028
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007029dst <ip_address>
7030 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7031 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007032
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007033dst_conn <integer>
7034 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7035 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7036 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7037 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7038 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7039 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7040
7041dst_port <integer>
7042 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7043 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7044
7045fe_conn <integer>
7046fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
7047 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7048 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7049 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7050 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7051 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7052 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7053 criteria.
7054
7055fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007056 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007057 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007058
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007059fe_sess_rate <integer>
7060fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
7061 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7062 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7063 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7064 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7065 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7066 the rate to go down below the limit.
7067
7068 Example :
7069 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7070 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7071 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7072 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7073 frontend mail
7074 bind :25
7075 mode tcp
7076 maxconn 100
7077 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7078 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7079 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7080 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007081
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007082nbsrv <integer>
7083nbsrv(backend) <integer>
7084 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7085 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7086 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7087 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7088 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007089
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007090queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02007091queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007092 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7093 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7094 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7095 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7096 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7097 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7098 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7099
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007100sc1_bytes_in_rate
7101sc2_bytes_in_rate
7102 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7103 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7104 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7105
7106sc1_bytes_out_rate
7107sc2_bytes_out_rate
7108 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7109 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7110 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7111
7112sc1_conn_cnt
7113sc2_conn_cnt
7114 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7115 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7116
7117sc1_conn_cur
7118sc2_conn_cur
7119 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7120 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7121 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7122
7123sc1_conn_rate
7124sc2_conn_rate
7125 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7126 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7127 See also src_conn_rate.
7128
7129sc1_get_gpc0
7130sc2_get_gpc0
7131 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7132 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7133
7134sc1_http_err_cnt
7135sc2_http_err_cnt
7136 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7137 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7138 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7139
7140sc1_http_err_rate
7141sc2_http_err_rate
7142 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7143 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7144 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7145 src_http_err_rate.
7146
7147sc1_http_req_cnt
7148sc2_http_req_cnt
7149 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7150 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7151 src_http_req_cnt.
7152
7153sc1_http_req_rate
7154sc2_http_req_rate
7155 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7156 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7157 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7158 src_http_req_rate.
7159
7160sc1_inc_gpc0
7161sc2_inc_gpc0
7162 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7163 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7164 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7165 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7166 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7167 when a first ACL was verified :
7168
7169 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7170 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7171 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7172
7173sc1_kbytes_in
7174sc2_kbytes_in
7175 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7176 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7177 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7178 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7179
7180sc1_kbytes_out
7181sc2_kbytes_out
7182 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7183 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7184 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7185 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7186
7187sc1_sess_cnt
7188sc2_sess_cnt
7189 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7190 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7191 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7192 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7193 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7194 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7195
7196sc1_sess_rate
7197sc2_sess_rate
7198 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7199 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7200 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7201 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7202 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7203 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7204
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007205so_id <integer>
7206 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7207
7208src <ip_address>
7209 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7210 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7211 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7212
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007213src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
7214src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
7215 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7216 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7217 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007218 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007219
7220src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
7221src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
7222 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7223 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7224 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007225 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007226
7227src_conn_cnt <integer>
7228src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
7229 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7230 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7231 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007232 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007233
7234src_conn_cur <integer>
7235src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
7236 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7237 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7238 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007239 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007240
7241src_conn_rate <integer>
7242src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
7243 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7244 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7245 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007246 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007247
7248src_get_gpc0 <integer>
7249src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
7250 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7251 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7252 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007253 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007254
7255src_http_err_cnt <integer>
7256src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
7257 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7258 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7259 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007260 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007261
7262src_http_err_rate <integer>
7263src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
7264 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7265 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7266 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7267 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007268 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007269
7270src_http_req_cnt <integer>
7271src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
7272 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7273 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7274 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007275 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007276
7277src_http_req_rate <integer>
7278src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
7279 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7280 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7281 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7282 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007283 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007284
7285src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
7286src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
7287 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7288 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7289 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7290 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7291 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7292 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7293
7294 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7295 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007296 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007297
7298src_kbytes_in <integer>
7299src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
7300 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7301 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7302 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7303 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007304 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007305
7306src_kbytes_out <integer>
7307src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
7308 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7309 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7310 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7311 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007312 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007313
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007314src_port <integer>
7315 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007316
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007317src_sess_cnt <integer>
7318src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
7319 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7320 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7321 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7322 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007323 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007324
7325src_sess_rate <integer>
7326src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
7327 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7328 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7329 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7330 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007331 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007332
7333src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
7334src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007335 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007336 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7337 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007338 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7339 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7340 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007341 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007342
7343 Example :
7344 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7345 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7346 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7347 listen ssh
7348 bind :22
7349 mode tcp
7350 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007351 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007352 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7353 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7354
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007355srv_id <integer>
7356 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7357
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007358srv_is_up(<server>)
7359srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7360 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7361 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7362 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7363 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7364 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7365 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7366 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7367 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007369
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020073707.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7371---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007372
7373A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7374during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007375through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7376keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007377
7378req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007379 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007380 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7381 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7382 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7383 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7384 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7385 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7386
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007387req_proto_http
7388 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7389 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007390 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007391 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7392 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7393
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007394req_rdp_cookie <string>
7395req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
7396 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7397 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7398 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7399 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7400 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7401 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7402 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7403 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7404
7405req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
7406req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
7407 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7408 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7409 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7410 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7411 cookies.
7412
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007413req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7414 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7415 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7416 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7417 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7418 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7419 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7420 with TCP request content inspection.
7421
Emeric Brun392d1d82010-09-24 15:45:16 +02007422req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7423 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7424 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7425 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7426 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7427
7428rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7429 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7430 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7431 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7432 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7433
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007434wait_end
7435 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7436 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7437 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7438 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7439 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7440 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7441 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7442 inspection.
7443
7444 Examples :
7445 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7446 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7447 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7448
7449 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7450 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7451 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7452 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7453 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7454 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7455 tcp-request content reject
7456
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007457
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074587.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7459--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007460
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007461A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007462application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7463read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7464than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7465
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007466hdr <string>
7467hdr(header) <string>
7468 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7469 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7470 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7471 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7472 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7473
7474 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7475 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7476 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7477
7478 hdr(Connection) -i close
7479
7480hdr_beg <string>
7481hdr_beg(header) <string>
7482 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7483 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7484 response headers sent by the server.
7485
7486hdr_cnt <integer>
7487hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7488 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7489 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7490 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7491 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7492 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7493 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7494 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7495
7496hdr_dir <string>
7497hdr_dir(header) <string>
7498 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7499 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7500 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7501 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7502 headers sent by the server.
7503
7504hdr_dom <string>
7505hdr_dom(header) <string>
7506 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7507 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7508 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7509 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7510 server.
7511
7512hdr_end <string>
7513hdr_end(header) <string>
7514 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7515 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7516 response headers sent by the server.
7517
7518hdr_ip <ip_address>
7519hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7520 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7521 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7522 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7523 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7524
7525hdr_reg <regex>
7526hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7527 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7528 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7529 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7530 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7531 response headers sent by the server.
7532
7533hdr_sub <string>
7534hdr_sub(header) <string>
7535 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7536 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7537 response headers sent by the server.
7538
7539hdr_val <integer>
7540hdr_val(header) <integer>
7541 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7542 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7543 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7544 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7545
7546http_auth(userlist)
7547http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7548 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7549 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7550 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7551 of specified groups.
7552
7553 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7554
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007555http_req_first
7556 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7557 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7558 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7559 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7560
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007561method <string>
7562 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7563 already check for most common methods.
7564
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007565path <string>
7566 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7567 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7568 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7569
7570path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007571 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7572 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007573
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007574path_dir <string>
7575 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7576 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7577 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7578 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7579
7580path_dom <string>
7581 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7582 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7583 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7584
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007585path_end <string>
7586 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7587 control file name extension.
7588
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007589path_reg <regex>
7590 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7591 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7592 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7593
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007594path_sub <string>
7595 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7596 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7597 "path_dir".
7598
7599req_ver <string>
7600 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7601 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7602
7603status <integer>
7604 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7605 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7606 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7607
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007608url <string>
7609 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7610 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7611
7612url_beg <string>
7613 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7614 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7615
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007616url_dir <string>
7617 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7618 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7619 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7620 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7621
7622url_dom <string>
7623 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7624 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7625 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7626
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007627url_end <string>
7628 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7629 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007630
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007631url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007632 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7633 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007634 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007635
7636url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007637 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7638 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007639 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007640 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007641
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007642url_reg <regex>
7643 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7644 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7645 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007646
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007647url_sub <string>
7648 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7649 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007650
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076527.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7653---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007655Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7656every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007657order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007659ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7660---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007661FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007662HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007663HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7664HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007665HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7666HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7667HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7668HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7669LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007670METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7671METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7672METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7673METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7674METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7675METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007676RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007677REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007678TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007679WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7680---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007681
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076837.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7684----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007686Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7687combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007689 - AND (implicit)
7690 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7691 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007692
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007693A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007695 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007697Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7698indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007699
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007700For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7701"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7702requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7703is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007705 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7706 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7707 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7708 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007710To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7711and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007713 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7714 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7715 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7716 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007718 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7719 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7720 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7721 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007722
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007723It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7724expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7725be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7726the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7727
7728 The following rule :
7729
7730 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7731 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7732
7733 Can also be written that way :
7734
7735 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7736
7737It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7738to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7739simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7740sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7741good use is the following :
7742
7743 With named ACLs :
7744
7745 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7746 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7747 monitor fail if site_dead
7748
7749 With anonymous ACLs :
7750
7751 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007753See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007754
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007755
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010077567.8. Pattern extraction
7757-----------------------
7758
7759The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7760response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7761for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7762
7763All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7764"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7765begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7766arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7767much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7768equivalent used in ACLs.
7769
7770The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7771
7772 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
7773 It is of type IP and only works with such tables.
7774
7775 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7776 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7777 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
7778 typie IP and only works with such tables.
7779
7780 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7781 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7782 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7783 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7784 type integer and only works with such tables.
7785
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007786 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7787 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7788 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7789 x-forwarded-for header.
7790
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007791 payload(offset,length)
7792 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
7793 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
7794 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
7795 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007796
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007797 payload_lv(offset1,length[,offset2])
7798 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
7799 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
7800 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
7801 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
7802 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
7803 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
7804 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
7805 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
7806
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09007807 url_param(name)
7808 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
7809 the query string of the request and uses the correponding value
7810 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url (e.g.
7811 http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
7812 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
7813
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007814The currently available list of transformations include :
7815
7816 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7817 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7818 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7819
7820 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7821 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7822 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7823
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007824 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7825 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7826 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7827 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7828 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7829
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078318. Logging
7832----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007833
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007834One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7835provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7836very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7837provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7838state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007839to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007840headers.
7841
7842In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7843about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7844send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7845
7846 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7847 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7848 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7849 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7850 at the termination.
7851
7852The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7853allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7854as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7855while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7856real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7857delay.
7858
7859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078608.1. Log levels
7861---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007862
7863TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with informations such as date, time,
7864source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
7865HTTP request, the HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, the conditions
7866in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values, to track a
7867particular user's problems for example. All messages are sent to up to two
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007868syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more info about log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007869facilities.
7870
7871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078728.2. Log formats
7873----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007874
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007875HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007876and will be detailed in the next sections. A few of them may slightly vary with
7877the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain options. The supported
7878formats are the following ones :
7879
7880 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7881 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7882 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
7883 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
7884 extents.
7885
7886 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
7887 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
7888 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
7889 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
7890 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
7891
7892 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
7893 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
7894 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
7895 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
7896 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
7897
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007898 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
7899 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
7900 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
7901 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
7902
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007903Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
7904specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
7905field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
7906servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
7907always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
7908identifier.
7909
7910Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
7911 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
7912 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
7913 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
7914 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
7915
7916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079178.2.1. Default log format
7918-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007919
7920This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
7921as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
7922format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
7923
7924 Example :
7925 listen www
7926 mode http
7927 log global
7928 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7929
7930 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
7931 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
7932 (www/HTTP)
7933
7934 Field Format Extract from the example above
7935 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
7936 2 'Connect from' Connect from
7937 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
7938 4 'to' to
7939 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
7940 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
7941
7942Detailed fields description :
7943 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
7944 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7945 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
7946 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
7947 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7948 and processed the connection.
7949 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
7950
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007951In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
7952"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
7953connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
7954
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007955It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
7956will eventually disappear.
7957
7958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079598.2.2. TCP log format
7960---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007961
7962The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
7963is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
7964information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
7965counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
7966emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
7967environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
7968the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
7969sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007970specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
7971not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
7972fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
7973marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007974
7975 Example :
7976 frontend fnt
7977 mode tcp
7978 option tcplog
7979 log global
7980 default_backend bck
7981
7982 backend bck
7983 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7984
7985 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
7986 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
7987 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
7988
7989 Field Format Extract from the example above
7990 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
7991 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
7992 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
7993 4 frontend_name fnt
7994 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
7995 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
7996 7 bytes_read* 212
7997 8 termination_state --
7998 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
7999 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8000
8001Detailed fields description :
8002 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008003 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8004 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8005 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8006 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8007 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008008
8009 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008010 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8011 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8012 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008013
8014 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8015 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8016 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8017 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8018
8019 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8020 and processed the connection.
8021
8022 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8023 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8024 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8025 applications.
8026
8027 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8028 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8029 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8030 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8031 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8032
8033 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8034 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8035 See "Timers" below for more details.
8036
8037 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8038 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8039 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8040 "Timers" below for more details.
8041
8042 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8043 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8044 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8045 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8046 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8047 details.
8048
8049 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8050 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8051 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8052 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8053 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8054
8055 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8056 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8057 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8058 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8059 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8060 for more details.
8061
8062 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8063 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8064 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8065 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8066 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008067 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008068
8069 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8070 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8071 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8072 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8073 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8074 caused by a denial of service attack.
8075
8076 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8077 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8078 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8079 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8080 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8081 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8082 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8083 denial of service attack.
8084
8085 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8086 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8087 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8088 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8089 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8090 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8091 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8092 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8093 be processed than on other servers.
8094
8095 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8096 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8097 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8098 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8099 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8100 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8101 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8102 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8103 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8104 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8105 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8106 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8107 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8108
8109 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8110 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8111 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8112 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8113 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8114 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8115 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8116 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8117
8118 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8119 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8120 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8121 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8122 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8123 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8124 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8125 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8126 occurs.
8127
8128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081298.2.3. HTTP log format
8130----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008131
8132The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8133is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8134the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8135are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8136emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8137generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8138"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8139which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008140frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8141is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008142
8143Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8144slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8145with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8146
8147 Example :
8148 frontend http-in
8149 mode http
8150 option httplog
8151 log global
8152 default_backend bck
8153
8154 backend static
8155 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8156
8157 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8158 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8159 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008160 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008161
8162 Field Format Extract from the example above
8163 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8164 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8165 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8166 4 frontend_name http-in
8167 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8168 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8169 7 status_code 200
8170 8 bytes_read* 2750
8171 9 captured_request_cookie -
8172 10 captured_response_cookie -
8173 11 termination_state ----
8174 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8175 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8176 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8177 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8178 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008179
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008180
8181Detailed fields description :
8182 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008183 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8184 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8185 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8186 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8187 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008188
8189 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008190 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8191 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8192 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008193
8194 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8195 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8196 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8197 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8198 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8199
8200 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8201 and processed the connection.
8202
8203 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8204 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8205 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8206
8207 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8208 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8209 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8210 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8211 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8212 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8213
8214 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8215 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8216 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8217 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8218 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8219 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8220
8221 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8222 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8223 See "Timers" below for more details.
8224
8225 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8226 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8227 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8228 below for more details.
8229
8230 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8231 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8232 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8233 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8234 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8235 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8236 for more details.
8237
8238 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8239 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8240 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8241 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8242 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8243 details.
8244
8245 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8246 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8247 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8248
8249 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8250 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8251 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8252 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8253 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8254 overflowing.
8255
8256 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8257 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8258 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8259 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8260 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8261 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8262 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8263 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8264
8265 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8266 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8267 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8268 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8269 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8270 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8271 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8272 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8273
8274 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8275 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8276 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8277 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8278 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8279 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8280 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8281
8282 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8283 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8284 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8285 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8286 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008287 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008288 system.
8289
8290 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8291 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8292 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8293 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8294 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8295 caused by a denial of service attack.
8296
8297 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8298 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8299 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8300 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8301 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8302 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8303 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8304 denial of service attack.
8305
8306 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8307 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8308 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8309 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8310 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8311 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8312 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8313 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8314 processed than on other servers.
8315
8316 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8317 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8318 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8319 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8320 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8321 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8322 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8323 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8324 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8325 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8326 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8327 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8328 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8329
8330 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8331 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8332 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8333 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8334 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8335 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8336 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8337 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8338
8339 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8340 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8341 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8342 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8343 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8344 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8345 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8346 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8347 occurs.
8348
8349 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8350 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8351 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8352 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8353 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8354 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8355 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8356 cookies" below for more details.
8357
8358 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8359 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8360 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8361 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8362 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8363 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8364 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8365 and cookies" below for more details.
8366
8367 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8368 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8369 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8370 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8371 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8372 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8373 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8374 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8375
8376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083778.3. Advanced logging options
8378-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008379
8380Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8381just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8382options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8383for more information about their usage.
8384
8385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083868.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8387------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008388
8389It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8390haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8391commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8392monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8393ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8394
8395 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8396 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8397 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8398 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8399
8400 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8401 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8402 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8403 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8404 such as other load-balancers.
8405
8406 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8407 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8408 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8409
8410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084118.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8412----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008413
8414The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8415what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8416or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8417"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8418just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8419log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8420after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8421is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8422with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8423with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8424
8425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084268.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8427------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008428
8429Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8430for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8431"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8432retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8433raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8434a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8435file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8436you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8437"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8438
8439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084408.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8441--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008442
8443Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8444multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8445them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8446"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8447logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8448error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8449and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8450too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8451useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8452alternative.
8453
8454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084558.4. Timing events
8456------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008457
8458Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8459reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8460the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8461frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8462mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8463
8464 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8465 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8466 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8467 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8468 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8469
8470 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8471 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8472 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8473 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8474 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8475
8476 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8477 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8478 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8479 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8480 connection never established.
8481
8482 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8483 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8484 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8485 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8486 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8487 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8488 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8489 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8490 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8491 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8492 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8493
8494 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8495 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8496 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8497 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8498 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8499
8500 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8501
8502 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8503 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8504 negative.
8505
8506These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8507protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8508that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008509due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008510close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8511session has been aborted on timeout.
8512
8513Most common cases :
8514
8515 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8516 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8517 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8518 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8519 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8520 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8521 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8522 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8523 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008524 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8525 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8526 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008527
8528 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8529 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8530 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8531 of ms on remote networks.
8532
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008533 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8534 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8535 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008536
8537 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8538 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8539 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8540 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8541 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8542 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8543 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8544 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8545 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8546 to the server until another one is released.
8547
8548Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8549
8550 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8551 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8552 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8553
8554 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8555 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8556 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8557
8558 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8559 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8560 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8561 flags.
8562
8563 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8564 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8565 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8566 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8567 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8568 the client connection was maintained open.
8569
8570 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8571 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8572 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8573 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8574
8575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085768.5. Session state at disconnection
8577-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008578
8579TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8580"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
85812-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8582each of which has a special meaning :
8583
8584 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8585 session to terminate :
8586
8587 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8588
8589 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8590 server explicitly refused it.
8591
8592 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8593 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8594 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8595 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8596 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8597 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8598
8599 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8600 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8601 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8602 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8603 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8604
8605 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8606 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8607 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8608 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8609 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8610
8611 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8612 send or receive data.
8613
8614 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8615 send or receive data.
8616
8617 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8618 with nothing left in the buffers.
8619
8620 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8621
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01008622 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008623 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8624
8625 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8626 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8627 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8628 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8629 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8630
8631 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8632 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8633
8634 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8635 server (HTTP only).
8636
8637 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8638
8639 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8640 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8641 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8642
8643 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8644 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8645 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8646
8647 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8648
8649 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8650 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8651
8652 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8653 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8654 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8655
8656 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8657 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008658 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8659 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008660
8661 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8662 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8663 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8664 another server.
8665
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008666 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008667 server.
8668
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008669 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8670 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8671 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8672 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8673
8674 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8675 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8676 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8677 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8678
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008679 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8680
8681 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8682 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8683
8684 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8685
8686 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8687 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8688 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8689
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008690 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8691 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8692 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8693 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8694 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8695
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008696 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8697
8698 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8699 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8700
8701 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8702
8703 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8704
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008705The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8706was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008707helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8708starvation, attacks, etc...
8709
8710The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8711alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8712easier finding and understanding.
8713
8714 Flags Reason
8715
8716 -- Normal termination.
8717
8718 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8719 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8720 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8721 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8722
8723 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8724 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8725 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8726 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8727 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8728 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008729
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008730 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8731 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8732 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8733
8734 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8735 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8736 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8737
8738 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8739 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8740 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8741 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8742 the server takes too long to respond.
8743
8744 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8745 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8746 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8747 long a time to respond.
8748
8749 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8750 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8751 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8752 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8753 and the client.
8754
8755 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8756 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8757 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8758 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8759 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8760 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8761
8762 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8763 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008764 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8765 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8766 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8767 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008769 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008770 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8771 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8772 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8773 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8774 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8775
8776 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8777 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8778 503 or 504 here.
8779
8780 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8781 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8782 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8783 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8784 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8785
8786 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8787 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008788 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008789 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8790 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8791
8792 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8793 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8794 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8795 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8796 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8797 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8798 between haproxy and the server.
8799
8800 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8801 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8802 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8803 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8804 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8805 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8806 solution is to fix the application.
8807
8808 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8809 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8810 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8811 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8812 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8813 external attacks.
8814
8815 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8816 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8817 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8818 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8819 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8820
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008821 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
8822 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
8823 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
8824 the client.
8825
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008826 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8827 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8828 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8829 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008830 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
8831 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
8832 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
8833 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
8834 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008835
8836 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8837 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8838 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8839 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8840
8841 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8842 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8843 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8844 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8845
8846 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8847 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8848 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8849 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8850
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008851The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
8852persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
8853important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
8854re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
8855
8856 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
8857
8858 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8859 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
8860 set on a GET request.
8861
8862 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
8863 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
8864 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
8865 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
8866
8867 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
8868 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
8869 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
8870
8871 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8872 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
8873 already got a cookie.
8874
8875 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8876 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
8877 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
8878 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
8879 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
8880
8881 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8882 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8883 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8884
8885 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
8886 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8887 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8888
8889 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
8890 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
8891
8892 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
8893 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
8894 then advertised in the response.
8895
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008896
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088978.6. Non-printable characters
8898-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008899
8900In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
8901consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
8902converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
8903prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
8904being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
8905escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
8906is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
8907'}' when logging headers.
8908
8909Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
8910issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
8911containing spaces is "User-Agent".
8912
8913Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
8914the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
8915performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
8916
8917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089188.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
8919---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008920
8921Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
8922achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008923section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008924cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
8925the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
8926the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008927locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008928not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
8929user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
8930a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
8931wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
8932
8933 Examples :
8934 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
8935 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
8936
8937 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
8938 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
8939
8940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089418.8. Capturing HTTP headers
8942---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008943
8944Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
8945proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
8946the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
8947server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
8948
8949Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
8950response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008951section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008952
8953It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008954time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
8955appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008956are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
8957and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
8958follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
8959request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
8960in the logs.
8961
8962 Example :
8963 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
8964 listen proxy-out
8965 mode http
8966 option httplog
8967 option logasap
8968 log global
8969 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
8970
8971 # log the name of the virtual server
8972 capture request header Host len 20
8973
8974 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
8975 capture request header Content-Length len 10
8976
8977 # log the beginning of the referrer
8978 capture request header Referer len 20
8979
8980 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
8981 capture response header Server len 20
8982
8983 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
8984 capture response header Content-Length len 10
8985
8986 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
8987 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
8988
8989 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
8990 capture response header Via len 20
8991
8992 # log the URL location during a redirection
8993 capture response header Location len 20
8994
8995 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
8996 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
8997 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8998 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
8999 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9000
9001 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9002 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9003 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9004 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009005 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009006
9007 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9008 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9009 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9010 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9011 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009012 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009013
9014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090158.9. Examples of logs
9016---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009017
9018These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9019them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9020reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9021
9022 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9023 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9024 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9025
9026 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9027 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9028
9029 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9030 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9031 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9032
9033 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9034 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9035
9036 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9037 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9038 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9039
9040 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009041 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009042 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9043 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9044
9045 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9046 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9047 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9048
9049 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9050 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
9051 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
9052 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9053 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9054 to return the 502 and not the server.
9055
9056 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009057 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009058
9059 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9060 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9061 Nothing was sent to any server.
9062
9063 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9064 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9065
9066 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9067 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9068 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9069 send a 408 return code to the client.
9070
9071 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9072 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9073
9074 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9075 5 seconds ("c----").
9076
9077 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9078 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009079 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009080
9081 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009082 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009083 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9084 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9085 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9086 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9087 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009088
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090909. Statistics and monitoring
9091----------------------------
9092
9093It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9094mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9095CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9096Unix socket.
9097
9098
90999.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009100---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009101
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009102The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9103page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009105 0. pxname: proxy name
9106 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9107 for server)
9108 2. qcur: current queued requests
9109 3. qmax: max queued requests
9110 4. scur: current sessions
9111 5. smax: max sessions
9112 6. slim: sessions limit
9113 7. stot: total sessions
9114 8. bin: bytes in
9115 9. bout: bytes out
9116 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009117 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009118 12. ereq: request errors
9119 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009120 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009121 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9122 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009123 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009124 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9125 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9126 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9127 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9128 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9129 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9130 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9131 25. qlimit: queue limit
9132 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9133 27. iid: unique proxy id
9134 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9135 29. throttle: warm up status
9136 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9137 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009138 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009139 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9140 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9141 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009142 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009143 UNK -> unknown
9144 INI -> initializing
9145 SOCKERR -> socket error
9146 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9147 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9148 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9149 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9150 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9151 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9152 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9153 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9154 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9155 disable-on-404
9156 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9157 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9158 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009159 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9160 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009161 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9162 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9163 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9164 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9165 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9166 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009167 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9168 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9169 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9170 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009171 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9172 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009173
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091759.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009176-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009177
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009178The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009179must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9180is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9181a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9182risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9183followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9184given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9185then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9186to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009187
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009188It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9189on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9190own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009191
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009192clear counters
9193 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9194 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9195 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9196 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9197 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9198
9199clear counters all
9200 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9201 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9202 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9203
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009204clear table <table> key <key>
9205 Remove entry <key> from the stick-table <table>. The key must be of the same
9206 type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4. This is typically used
9207 un unblock some users complaining they have been abusively denied access to a
9208 service, but this can also be used to clear some stickiness entries matching
9209 a server that is going to be replaced (see "show table" below for details).
9210 Note that sometimes, removal of a key will be refused because it is currently
9211 tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds later after the session ends is
9212 usuall enough.
9213
9214 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009215 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009216 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009217 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9218 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9219 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9220 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009221
9222 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9223
9224 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009225 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009226 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9227 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009228
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009229disable server <backend>/<server>
9230 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9231 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9232 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9233 during the maintenance.
9234
9235 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9236 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9237
9238 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9239 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9240
9241 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9242 level "admin".
9243
9244enable server <backend>/<server>
9245 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9246 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9247
9248 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9249 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9250
9251 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9252 level "admin".
9253
9254get weight <backend>/<server>
9255 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9256 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9257 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9258 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9259 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
9260 dash ('#').
9261
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009262help
9263 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9264 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009265
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009266prompt
9267 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9268 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9269 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9270 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9271 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9272 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9273 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9274 command.
9275
9276quit
9277 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009278
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009279set timeout cli <delay>
9280 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9281 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9282 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9283
9284set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9285 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9286 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9287 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9288 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9289 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9290 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9291 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9292 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9293 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9294 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9295 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9296 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9297 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
9298 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9299
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009300show errors [<iid>]
9301 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9302 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009303 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9304 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9305 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009306
9307 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9308 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9309 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9310 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9311 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9312 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9313 are reported too.
9314
9315 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9316 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9317 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9318 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9319 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9320 code.
9321
9322 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9323 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9324 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9325 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9326 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9327 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9328 line.
9329
9330 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009331 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9332 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009333 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9334 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9335
9336 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9337 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9338 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9339 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9340 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9341 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9342 00204+ minal\r\n
9343 00211 \r\n
9344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009345 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009346 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9347 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9348 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9349 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9350 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9351 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009352
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009353show info
9354 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9355
9356show sess
9357 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009358 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9359 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9360
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009361show sess <id>
9362 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9363 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9364 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9365 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9366 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9367 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009368
9369show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9370 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9371 possible to dump only selected items :
9372 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9373 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9374 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9375 for example:
9376 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9377 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9378 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9379
9380 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009381 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9382 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009383 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9384 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9385 Nbproc: 1
9386 Process_num: 1
9387 (...)
9388
9389 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9390 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9391 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9392 (...)
9393 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9394
9395 $
9396
9397 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9398 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9399 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9400 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009401 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009402
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009403show table
9404 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9405 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9406 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9407 entries currently in use.
9408
9409 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009410 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9411 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
9412 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009413
9414show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ]
9415 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9416 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9417 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
9418 a filter in order to specify what entries to display. The filter then applies
9419 to the stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2). One stored data type
9420 has to be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table
9421 otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator>
9422 with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9423 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9424 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9425 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9426 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9427 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9428 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9429
9430 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009431 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9432 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9433 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9434 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9435 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9436 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009437
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009438 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9439 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9440 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9441 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009442
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009443 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9444 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9445 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9446 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9447 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009448
9449 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9450 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9451 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9452 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9453 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9454
9455 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9456 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9457 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009458 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9459 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009460 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9461 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009463/*
9464 * Local variables:
9465 * fill-column: 79
9466 * End:
9467 */